]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - etc/NEWS
*** empty log message ***
[gnu-emacs] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 See the end for copying conditions.
4
5 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
6 For older news, see the file ONEWS
7
8 Temporary note:
9 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
10 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
11 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
12 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
13
14 \f
15 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.4
16
17 ---
18 ** A Bulgarian translation of the Emacs Tutorial is available.
19
20 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
21 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
22 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
23
24 ---
25 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
26
27 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with elisp code.
28
29 ---
30 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
31 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
32 installed programs.
33
34 ---
35 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
36 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
37 place for game scores to be stored. This may be controlled by the
38 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
39 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
40 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
41 in each user's home directory.
42
43 ---
44 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
45 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
46 Emacs with Leim.
47
48 +++
49 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
50
51 The ELisp reference manual in Info format is built as part of the
52 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
53 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
54 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
55
56 ---
57 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
58 the distribution.
59
60 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
61 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
62 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
63 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
64
65 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
66
67 ---
68 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
69
70 ---
71 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
72
73 ---
74 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
75 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
76
77 ---
78 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
79
80 ---
81 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
82
83 ---
84 ** A French translation of the Emacs Tutorial is available.
85 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
86 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
87
88 \f
89 * Changes in Emacs 21.4
90
91 ---
92 ** The IELM prompt is now, by default, read-only. This can be
93 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only'.
94
95 ** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
96 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
97
98 ** Telnet will now prompt you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
99
100 +++
101 ** New command line option -Q.
102
103 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
104 the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, the blinking
105 cursor, and the fancy startup screen.
106
107 ** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
108 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
109
110 ** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
111 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
112 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
113
114 ** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
115 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
116 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
117 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it will stay at
118 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
119 just put point at the end of the buffer and it will stay there. This
120 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior may
121 be mode dependent.
122
123 ** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
124 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
125 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
126 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
127 mode will only revert a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
128 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
129 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
130 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
131 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
132
133 ** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
134 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
135 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
136 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
137 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
138
139 ** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
140 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
141 mode.
142
143 ** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
144
145 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
146 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
147 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
148 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
149
150 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
151 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
152 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
153
154 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
155 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
156 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
157 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
158 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
159
160 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
161
162 ** M-x grep has been adapted to new compile
163
164 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
165 can be saved and will again be loaded with the new `grep-mode'.
166
167 ** M-x diff uses diff-mode instead of compilation-mode.
168
169 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
170 resync points in both windows.
171
172 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
173 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
174 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
175 using strokes as an input method.
176
177 ---
178 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
179 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
180 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
181 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
182 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
183 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
184 feature.
185
186 ** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
187
188 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
189 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
190 % emacsclient -s foo file1
191 % emacsclient -s bar file2
192
193 ** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
194 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
195 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
196 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
197 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
198
199 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' may be set to nil to
200 revert to the old behaviour of continuing such lines.
201
202 ** The buffer boundaries (i.e. first and last line in the buffer) may
203 now be marked with angle bitmaps in the fringes. In addition, up and
204 down arrow bitmaps may be shown at the top and bottom of the left or
205 right fringe if the window can be scrolled in either direction.
206
207 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
208 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
209 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
210
211 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
212 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp. Any other non-nil value
213 causes the bitmap on the top line to be displayed in the left fringe,
214 and the bitmap on the bottom line in the right fringe.
215
216 If value is a cons (ANGLES . ARROWS), the car specifies the position
217 of the angle bitmaps, and the cdr specifies the position of the arrow
218 bitmaps.
219
220 For example, (t . right) places the top angle bitmap in left fringe,
221 the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both arrow bitmaps in
222 right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the left fringe, but
223 no arrow bitmaps, use (left . nil).
224
225 ** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
226 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
227 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
228 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
229 keyboard oriented alternative.
230
231 ** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
232 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
233 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
234 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
235 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
236
237 ** New commands `scan-buf-next-region' and `scan-buf-previous-region'
238 move to the start of the next (previous, respectively) region with
239 non-nil help-echo property and display any help found there in the
240 echo area, using `display-local-help'.
241
242 +++
243 ** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
244 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
245 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
246 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
247 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
248 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
249 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
250
251 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
252 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
253
254 +++
255 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
256 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
257 an interactively callable function.
258
259
260 ** sql changes.
261
262 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
263 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
264 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
265 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
266 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
267
268 The following values are supported:
269
270 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
271 db2 DB2
272 informix Informix
273 ingres Ingres
274 interbase Interbase
275 linter Linter
276 ms Microsoft
277 mysql MySQL
278 oracle Oracle
279 postgres Postgres
280 solid Solid
281 sqlite SQLite
282 sybase Sybase
283
284 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
285 SQL mode indicator.
286
287 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
288 your .emacs will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
289 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
290
291 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
292 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
293 all identifiers ending in "_t" under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
294 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
295
296 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
297 '("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face))
298
299 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i. Most
300 SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
301 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
302
303 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
304 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
305 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
306 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
307 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
308 terminated.
309
310 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
311 called with the -E command line argument to use the operating system
312 credentials to authenticate the user.
313
314 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
315 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
316 defaults.
317
318 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
319 appropriate sql-interactive-mode wrapper for the current setting of
320 `sql-product'.
321
322 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
323 with special modes such as Tar mode.
324
325 ** Enhancements to apropos commands:
326
327 *** The apropos commands will now accept a list of words to match.
328 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
329 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
330 available.
331
332 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
333 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
334 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
335 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
336 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
337 matching item.
338
339 +++
340 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
341 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
342 the operating system or your X server.
343
344 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
345 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
346 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
347
348 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
349 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
350
351 ** Dired mode:
352
353 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
354 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
355 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
356
357 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' to mark files with
358 different file attributes in two dired buffers.
359
360 +++
361 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
362 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
363 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
364 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
365 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
366 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
367
368 +++
369 *** Dired's v command now runs external viewers to view certain
370 types of files. The variable `dired-view-command-alist' controls
371 what external viewers to use and when.
372
373 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
374 into the kill ring.
375
376 ** Info mode:
377 +++
378 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
379 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
380 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
381
382 *** The new command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
383 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
384 possible matches.
385
386 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
387 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
388 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
389 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
390
391 +++
392 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
393
394 ---
395 *** Info-index offers completion.
396
397 ** Support for the SQLite interpreter has been added to sql.el by calling
398 'sql-sqlite'.
399
400 ** BibTeX mode:
401 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
402 *** bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries can take values `plain',
403 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
404 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
405 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
406 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
407 bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries is non-nil.
408
409 *** If the new variable bibtex-parse-keys-fast is non-nil,
410 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
411
412 *** If the new variable bibtex-autoadd-commas is non-nil,
413 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
414
415 *** The new variable bibtex-autofill-types contains a list of entry
416 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
417
418 *** The new command bibtex-complete completes word fragment before
419 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
420
421 *** The new commands bibtex-find-entry and bibtex-find-crossref
422 locate entries and crossref'd entries.
423
424 *** In BibTeX mode the command fill-paragraph (bound to M-q) fills
425 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
426
427 ** When display margins are present in a window, the fringes are now
428 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
429 at the edges of the window.
430
431 ** A window may now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
432 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
433
434 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
435 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
436 or when the frame is resized.
437
438 ** New functions frame-current-scroll-bars and window-current-scroll-bars.
439
440 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
441 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
442
443 ---
444 ** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
445 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
446 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
447
448 ** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
449
450 ** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which may
451 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
452
453 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
454 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
455
456 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
457
458 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
459 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
460
461 ** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
462 Emacs will prompt her for confirmation.
463
464 ** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
465
466 ** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
467 and other common debugger commands.
468
469 ** recentf changes.
470
471 The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
472 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
473 automatic cleanup.
474
475 With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
476 specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
477 example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
478 recent list with different symbolic links.
479
480 To follow naming convention, `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-flag'
481 and `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag' respectively replace the
482 misnamed options `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p' and
483 `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The old names remain available as
484 aliases, but have been marked obsolete.
485
486 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
487 from the locale.
488
489 ** Init file changes
490
491 You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
492 ~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
493
494 ** partial-completion-mode now does partial completion on directory names.
495
496 ** skeleton.el now supports using - to mark the skeleton-point without
497 interregion interaction. @ has reverted to only setting
498 skeleton-positions and no longer sets skeleton-point. Skeletons
499 which used @ to mark skeleton-point independent of _ should now use -
500 instead. The updated skeleton-insert docstring explains these new
501 features along with other details of skeleton construction.
502
503 ** MH-E changes.
504
505 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.3. There have been major changes since
506 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
507
508 +++
509 ** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
510 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given elisp
511 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
512
513 ** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
514
515 +++
516 ** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
517 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
518 appears between the position information and the major mode.
519
520 ** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
521 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
522
523 +++
524 ** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
525 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
526 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
527 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
528 set-fringe-style.
529
530 +++
531 ** There is a new user option `mail-default-directory' that allows you
532 to specify the value of `default-directory' for mail buffers. This
533 directory is used for auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to
534 "~/".
535
536 +++
537 ** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
538 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
539 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you will in fact be able
540 to alter the file.)
541
542 ** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
543 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
544
545 ** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
546 of a file.
547
548 ---
549 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
550
551 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
552 ps-print, provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF fonts.
553 See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
554
555 ---
556 ** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
557 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
558 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
559
560 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
561 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
562 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories will be
563 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
564 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
565
566 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
567 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
568 t, and the status is shown.
569
570 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
571 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
572
573 +++
574 ** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
575 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
576 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
577 faces.
578
579 ** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
580 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
581 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
582 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
583 automatically according to the locale.)
584
585 ** Indian support has been updated.
586 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
587 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
588 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
589 supported.
590
591 ---
592 ** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
593 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
594 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
595 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
596 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
597 tamil-inscript.
598
599 ---
600 ** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
601 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
602 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
603
604 ---
605 ** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
606 library. These include complete versions of most of those in
607 codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now
608 obsolete and is used only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. windows-1252
609 and windows-1251 are preloaded since the former is so common and the
610 latter is used by GNU locales.
611
612 ** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
613 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences (mostly representing CJK
614 characters) are simply composed into single quasi-characters. User
615 option `utf-translate-cjk' arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK
616 character sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the
617 Mule-UCS system. This uses significant space, so is not the default.
618 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
619 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
620 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
621 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
622 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
623
624 ** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
625 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
626 fontset appropriately.
627
628 ** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
629 unicode.
630
631 +++
632 ** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
633 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
634 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
635 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
636 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
637 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
638 mule-unicode-... ones.
639
640 By default this translation will happen automatically on encoding.
641 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
642 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
643 possible.
644
645 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
646 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
647 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
648 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
649 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
650
651 ** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
652 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
653 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
654 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
655
656 ** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
657 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
658 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
659 command.
660
661 ---
662 ** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
663 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
664 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
665
666 ---
667 ** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
668 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+ and W32).
669
670 ---
671 ** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif pops down when pressing ESC.
672
673 +++
674 ** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
675 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
676
677 +++
678 ** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
679 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
680 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
681 cursor does.
682
683 +++
684 ** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
685 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
686
687 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
688 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
689 program files that include other program files.
690
691 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
692 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
693 in them.
694
695 ---
696 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
697 when Emacs visits them.
698
699 ---
700 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
701
702 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
703 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
704 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
705
706 ** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
707 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
708 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
709 and use the more appropriately result.
710
711 +++
712 ** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
713 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
714 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
715 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
716
717 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
718 hscrolling will scroll the window when point gets too close to the
719 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
720 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
721 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
722 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
723
724 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
725 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
726
727 ** TeX modes:
728 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
729 +++
730 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
731 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
732 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
733 TeX commands to use at startup.
734 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
735 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
736
737 *** New major mode doctex-mode for *.dtx files.
738
739 +++
740 ** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
741 to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
742 mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
743 different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
744 be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
745 feature is not enabled.
746
747 ** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
748 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
749 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
750 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
751 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
752 to give it focus.
753
754 +++
755 ** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
756 description various information about a character, including its
757 encodings and syntax, its text properties, overlays, and widgets at
758 point. You can get more information about some of them, by clicking
759 on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
760
761 +++
762 ** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
763 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
764 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
765 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
766 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
767
768 +++
769 ** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
770 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
771 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
772 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
773 also disable mouse highlighting.
774
775 +++
776 ** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
777 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
778 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
779 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
780 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
781
782 +++
783 ** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
784 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
785 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
786 prompt string.
787
788 +++
789 ** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
790 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
791 the mode line of the currently selected window.
792
793 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
794 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
795
796 ---
797 ** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
798 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
799 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
800 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
801 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
802 current date and time, current line and column number in the
803 mode-line.
804
805 ---
806 ** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
807
808 +++
809 ** Emacs can now indicate in the mode-line the presence of new e-mail
810 in a directory or in a file. See the documentation of the user option
811 `display-time-mail-directory'.
812
813 ---
814 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
815
816 +++
817 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
818 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
819 argument it toggles the mode.
820
821 Turning off PC-Selection mode restores the global key bindings
822 that were replaced by turning on the mode.
823
824 +++
825 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
826 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
827 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
828 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
829 `inhibit-splash-screen').
830
831 ** Changes in support of colors on character terminals
832
833 +++
834 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
835 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
836 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
837 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
838 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
839 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
840 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
841 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
842 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
843
844 ---
845 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
846 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
847 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
848 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
849 all of these colors.
850
851 +++
852 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
853 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
854 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
855 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
856 colors as on X.
857
858 ---
859 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
860
861 +++
862 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
863
864 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
865 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
866 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
867 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
868
869 ---
870 ** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
871 automatically.
872
873 +++
874 ** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
875 modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
876 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
877 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
878
879 +++
880 ** Changes in C-h bindings:
881
882 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
883
884 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
885 that do not change:
886
887 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
888 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
889
890 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
891 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
892
893 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
894
895 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
896 run by the key sequence.
897
898 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
899 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
900 that command.
901
902 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
903 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
904
905 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
906 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
907
908 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
909 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
910
911 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
912 new-kill-line is on C-k
913
914 +++
915 ** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
916 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
917 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
918 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
919
920 +++
921 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
922 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
923 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
924 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
925
926 +++
927 ** Occur, Info, and comint-derived modes now support using
928 M-x font-lock-mode to toggle fontification. The variable
929 `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable fontification,
930 remove `turn-on-font-lock' from `Info-mode-hook'.
931
932 +++
933 ** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
934 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep will automatically
935 detect whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
936 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
937 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
938 command lines to be used than was possible before.
939
940 ---
941 ** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
942 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
943 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
944 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
945 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
946 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
947 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
948
949 +++
950 ** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
951 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
952 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
953 under the "[State]" button.
954
955 ** The new customization type `float' specifies numbers with floating
956 point (no integers are allowed).
957
958 +++
959 ** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
960 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
961
962 ---
963 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
964
965 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
966 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
967 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
968 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
969 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
970
971 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
972 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
973 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
974 (gud-finish).
975
976 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
977 (Java 1.1 jdb).
978
979 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
980 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
981 Set gud-jdb-use-classpath to nil.
982
983 Added Customization Variables
984
985 *** gud-jdb-command-name. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
986
987 *** gud-jdb-use-classpath. Allows selection of java source file searching
988 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan gud-jdb-directories for
989 java sources (previous method).
990
991 *** gud-jdb-directories. List of directories to scan and search for java
992 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if gud-jdb-use-classpath
993 is nil).
994
995 Minor Improvements
996
997 *** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
998
999 +++
1000 ** hide-ifdef-mode now uses overlays rather than selective-display
1001 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
1002 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
1003
1004 +++
1005 ** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
1006 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
1007 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
1008 is only rarely needed.
1009
1010 ---
1011 ** JIT-lock changes
1012 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
1013
1014 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
1015 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
1016 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
1017 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
1018
1019 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
1020
1021 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
1022 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
1023 refontification takes place.
1024
1025 +++
1026 ** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times. If
1027 you hit M-C-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h (mark-paragraph), or
1028 C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region will now be extended
1029 each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC M-C-SPC,
1030 for example. This feature also works for mark-end-of-sentence, if you
1031 bind that to a key.
1032
1033 +++
1034 ** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
1035 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
1036 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
1037 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
1038 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
1039 command only.
1040
1041 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
1042 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
1043 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
1044 mark or the region.
1045
1046 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
1047 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
1048 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
1049 C-g.
1050
1051 +++
1052 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
1053 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... will cycle through the
1054 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
1055
1056 +++
1057 ** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1058 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1059 switching to it.
1060
1061 +++
1062 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
1063 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
1064 affects the initial frame.
1065
1066 +++
1067 ** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
1068 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
1069 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
1070 paragraphs.
1071
1072 +++
1073 ** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1074 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1075 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1076 directory listing into a buffer.
1077
1078 ---
1079 ** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
1080 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
1081
1082 ** Unexpected yanking of text due to accidental clicking on the mouse
1083 wheel button (typically mouse-2) during wheel scrolling is now avoided.
1084 This behaviour can be customized via the mouse-wheel-click-event and
1085 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
1086
1087 +++
1088 ** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1089 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1090 may mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1091 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1092 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1093 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1094 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1095 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
1096
1097 +++
1098 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
1099 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
1100 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
1101 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
1102 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
1103
1104 +++
1105 ** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
1106 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
1107 appears in.
1108
1109 ** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
1110 of the recognized cursor types.
1111
1112 ---
1113 ** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
1114 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
1115 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
1116
1117 +++
1118 ** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
1119 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
1120 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
1121 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
1122 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
1123 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
1124 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
1125 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
1126 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
1127
1128 +++
1129 ** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
1130 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
1131 count backward from the end of the year.
1132
1133 ** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
1134 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
1135 and `diary-header-line-format'.
1136
1137 +++
1138 ** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed: use
1139 the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
1140 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
1141 appt-issue-message, appt-visible, and appt-msg-window.
1142
1143 ** VC Changes
1144
1145 *** The key C-x C-q no longer checks files in or out, it only changes
1146 the read-only state of the buffer (toggle-read-only). We made this
1147 change because we held a poll and found that many users were unhappy
1148 with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this behavior, you
1149 can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your .emacs:
1150
1151 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
1152
1153 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
1154
1155 +++
1156 *** There is a new user option `vc-cvs-global-switches' that allows
1157 you to specify switches that are passed to any CVS command invoked
1158 by VC. These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which
1159 means they are inserted before the command name. For example, this
1160 allows you to specify a compression level using the "-z#" option for
1161 CVS.
1162
1163 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
1164
1165 ** EDiff changes.
1166
1167 +++
1168 *** When comparing directories.
1169 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
1170 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
1171 from one directory to another.
1172
1173 +++
1174 *** When comparing files or buffers.
1175 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
1176 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
1177 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
1178 comparison.
1179
1180 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
1181 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
1182 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
1183
1184 +++
1185 ** Etags changes.
1186
1187 *** New regular expressions features
1188
1189 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
1190 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
1191 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
1192 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
1193 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
1194 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
1195 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
1196 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
1197 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
1198 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
1199 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
1200
1201 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in Gcc.
1202 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
1203 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
1204 CR, TAB, VT,
1205
1206 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
1207 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
1208 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
1209 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
1210
1211 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
1212 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
1213 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
1214
1215 *** New language parsing features
1216
1217 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
1218 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
1219
1220 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
1221 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
1222 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
1223 package::sub.
1224
1225 **** New language PHP.
1226 Tags are functions, classes and defines.
1227 If the --members option is specified to etags, tags are vars also.
1228
1229 **** New language HTML.
1230 Title and h1, h2, h3 are tagged. Also, tags are generated when name= is
1231 used inside an anchor and whenever id= is used.
1232
1233 **** New default keywords for TeX.
1234 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
1235 renewenvironment.
1236
1237 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
1238 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
1239 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
1240
1241 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
1242
1243 *** Honour #line directives.
1244 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
1245 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
1246 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
1247 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
1248 writes tags pointing to the source file.
1249
1250 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
1251 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
1252 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
1253 will read from standard input and mark the produced tags as belonging to
1254 the file FILE.
1255
1256 +++
1257 ** CC Mode changes.
1258
1259 *** Font lock support.
1260 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1261 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1262 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1263 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1264 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1265 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
1266
1267 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1268 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1269 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1270 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1271 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1272 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1273 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1274 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1275 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
1276
1277 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1278 fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1279 with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1280 (e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1281 mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1282 take the better part of a minute.
1283
1284 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1285 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1286 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
1287 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
1288 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
1289 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
1290
1291 **** Support for documentation comments.
1292 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
1293 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
1294 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
1295 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
1296
1297 Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
1298 and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
1299 list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
1300 is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1301
1302 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
1303 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
1304 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
1305 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
1306 parens.
1307
1308 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
1309 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
1310 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
1311 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
1312 not as configurable as it ought to be.
1313
1314 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
1315 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
1316 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
1317 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
1318 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
1319
1320 *** Support for the AWK language.
1321 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
1322 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
1323 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
1324 Here is a summary:
1325
1326 **** Indentation Engine
1327 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
1328
1329 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
1330 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
1331 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
1332 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
1333 definition, or structured statement.
1334
1335 The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
1336 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
1337 any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
1338
1339 The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
1340 though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
1341 fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
1342 C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
1343
1344 **** Font Locking
1345 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
1346 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
1347 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
1348 the AWK language itself.
1349
1350 **** Comment Commands
1351 M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
1352 comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
1353
1354 **** Movement Commands
1355 Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
1356 exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
1357 (c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
1358
1359 The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
1360 pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
1361 recognise these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
1362 functions.
1363
1364 **** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
1365 Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
1366 the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
1367 invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
1368
1369 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
1370 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
1371 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
1372 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
1373 composition-close, and incomposition.
1374
1375 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
1376 The functions c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forward can be
1377 bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
1378 Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
1379
1380 *** Better control over require-final-newline.
1381 The variable that controls how to handle a final newline when the
1382 buffer is saved, require-final-newline, is now customizable on a
1383 per-mode basis through c-require-final-newline. The default is to set
1384 it to t only in languages that mandate a final newline in source files
1385 (C, C++ and Objective-C).
1386
1387 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
1388 The elements in the syntactic context returned by c-guess-basic-syntax
1389 and stored in c-syntactic-context has been changed somewhat to allow
1390 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
1391 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
1392
1393 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
1394
1395 is now analysed as
1396
1397 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
1398
1399 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
1400 symbol.
1401
1402 This change might affect code that call c-guess-basic-syntax directly,
1403 and custom lineup functions if they use c-syntactic-context. However,
1404 the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
1405 with nil or an integer in the cdr.
1406
1407 *** API changes for derived modes.
1408 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
1409 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
1410 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
1411 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
1412 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
1413
1414 **** New language variable system.
1415 See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
1416
1417 **** New initialization functions.
1418 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
1419 give better control: c-basic-common-init, c-font-lock-init, and
1420 c-init-language-vars.
1421
1422 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
1423 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
1424 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
1425 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
1426
1427 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
1428 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
1429 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
1430 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
1431 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1432
1433 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
1434 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
1435 its substatement. E.g:
1436
1437 if (x)
1438 x_is_true:
1439 do_stuff();
1440
1441 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
1442
1443 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
1444 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
1445 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
1446 variable c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros. A new syntactic symbol
1447 cpp-define-intro has been added to control the initial indentation
1448 inside #define's.
1449
1450 **** New lineup function c-lineup-cpp-define.
1451 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
1452 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
1453 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
1454 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
1455 much line c-lineup-dont-change, which was used earlier, but handles
1456 empty lines within the macro better.
1457
1458 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
1459 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
1460 c-context-line-break and c-context-open-line.
1461
1462 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
1463 c-backslash-region tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
1464 variable c-backslash-max-column which put a limit on how far out
1465 backslashes can be moved.
1466
1467 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
1468 This is controlled by the new variable c-auto-align-backslashes. It
1469 affects c-context-line-break, c-context-open-line and newlines
1470 inserted in auto-newline mode.
1471
1472 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
1473 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
1474 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
1475 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
1476 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
1477 backslash) in the macro.
1478
1479 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
1480 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
1481 the variable c-indent-comment-alist. The indentation behavior based
1482 on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
1483 and #endif but indentation to comment-column in most other cases
1484 (something which was hardcoded earlier).
1485
1486 *** New function c-context-open-line.
1487 It's the open-line equivalent of c-context-line-break.
1488
1489 *** New lineup functions
1490
1491 **** c-lineup-string-cont
1492 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
1493 continues. E.g:
1494
1495 result = prefix + "A message "
1496 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
1497
1498 **** c-lineup-cascaded-calls
1499 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
1500
1501 **** c-lineup-knr-region-comment
1502 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
1503 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
1504
1505 **** c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg
1506 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks. Contributed by Kevin
1507 Ryde.
1508
1509 **** c-lineup-argcont
1510 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
1511 Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
1512
1513 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
1514 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
1515 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
1516 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
1517 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
1518 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
1519
1520 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
1521 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
1522 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
1523 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
1524 context.
1525
1526 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
1527 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
1528 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
1529 happen when macros are involved.
1530
1531 *** Improved the way c-indent-exp chooses the block to indent.
1532 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
1533 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
1534 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
1535 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
1536 line is left untouched.
1537
1538 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
1539 The function c-toggle-syntactic-indentation can be used to toggle
1540 syntactic indentation.
1541
1542 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
1543 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
1544
1545 +++
1546 ** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
1547 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
1548
1549 +++
1550 ** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1551 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1552 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1553
1554 +++
1555 ** You can now customize fill-nobreak-predicate to control where
1556 filling can break lines. We provide two sample predicates,
1557 fill-single-word-nobreak-p and fill-french-nobreak-p.
1558
1559 +++
1560 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1561 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry will always
1562 start a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1563
1564 +++
1565 ** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
1566 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
1567 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
1568 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
1569 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
1570 from the file name or buffer contents.
1571
1572 +++
1573 ** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
1574
1575 +++
1576 ** New user option `isearch-resume-enabled'.
1577 This option can be disabled, to avoid the normal behavior of isearch
1578 which puts calls to `isearch-resume' in the command history.
1579
1580 ---
1581 ** Lisp mode now uses font-lock-doc-face for the docstrings.
1582
1583 ---
1584 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
1585
1586 +++
1587 ** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
1588 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
1589 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
1590
1591 ---
1592 ** F90 mode has new navigation commands `f90-end-of-block',
1593 `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block', `f90-previous-block'.
1594
1595 ---
1596 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
1597 to support use of font-lock.
1598
1599 +++
1600 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
1601 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
1602 `same-window'.
1603
1604 +++
1605 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variables of the form `$foo' and
1606 `${foo}' in the specified new value of the environment variable. To
1607 include a `$' in the value, use `$$'.
1608
1609 +++
1610 ** File-name completion can now ignore directories.
1611 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
1612 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
1613 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
1614 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
1615 candidate is a directory.
1616
1617 +++
1618 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
1619 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
1620 it remains unchanged.
1621
1622 ** Enhanced visual feedback in *Completions* buffer.
1623
1624 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
1625 have in common and where they begin to differ.
1626
1627 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
1628 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
1629 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
1630 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
1631 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
1632 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
1633 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
1634 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
1635
1636 +++
1637 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
1638 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
1639 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
1640
1641 ** Compilation mode enhancements:
1642
1643 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1644 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1645 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1646 subprocesses inherit.
1647
1648 *** `next-error' now temporarily highlights the corresponding source line.
1649
1650 ** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
1651
1652 *** Grep commands now have their own submenu and customization group.
1653
1654 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
1655 `grep-scroll-output' can be used to override the corresponding
1656 compilation mode settings for grep commands.
1657
1658 *** Source line is temporarily highlighted when going to next match.
1659
1660 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
1661 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1662 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1663 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1664 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1665 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1666 file.
1667
1668 ---
1669 ** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
1670
1671 ---
1672 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
1673 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
1674 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
1675
1676 ---
1677 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
1678 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
1679
1680 ---
1681 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
1682 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
1683 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
1684 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
1685 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
1686 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
1687 against.
1688
1689 ---
1690 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
1691 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
1692 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
1693 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
1694 sound support for those formats.
1695
1696 ---
1697 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
1698 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
1699
1700 ---
1701 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
1702 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
1703 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
1704 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
1705
1706 ---
1707 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
1708 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in
1709 much the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now
1710 adds these colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu
1711 for the default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground),
1712 and uses some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
1713 `list-colors-display' will show the list of System color names if you
1714 wish to use them in other faces.
1715
1716 +++
1717 ** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
1718 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
1719 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
1720 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
1721 Meta and Alt:
1722 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
1723 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
1724
1725 +++
1726 ** vc-annotate-mode enhancements
1727
1728 In vc-annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
1729 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
1730 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
1731
1732 P: annotates the previous revision
1733 N: annotates the next revision
1734 J: annotates the revision at line
1735 A: annotates the revision previous to line
1736 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
1737 L: shows the log of the revision at line
1738 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
1739 \f
1740 * New modes and packages in Emacs 21.4
1741
1742 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
1743
1744 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
1745
1746 +++
1747 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
1748 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
1749
1750 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
1751
1752 ---
1753 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1754
1755 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
1756 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
1757 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
1758 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
1759
1760 ---
1761 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1762
1763 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
1764 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
1765 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
1766 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
1767 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
1768 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
1769
1770 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
1771 rectangle highlighting: Use S-return to start a rectangle, extend it
1772 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
1773 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
1774
1775 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
1776 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
1777 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
1778 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
1779 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
1780 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
1781 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
1782
1783 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
1784 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
1785 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
1786
1787 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
1788 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
1789
1790 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
1791 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
1792 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
1793 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
1794
1795 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
1796 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
1797 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you may customize the
1798 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
1799
1800 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
1801 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
1802 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
1803 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
1804
1805 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
1806 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
1807 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
1808 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
1809 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
1810
1811 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
1812 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
1813 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
1814 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
1815 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
1816 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
1817
1818 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
1819 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
1820 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
1821 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
1822 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
1823 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
1824 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
1825 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
1826 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
1827 or local keymaps.
1828
1829 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
1830 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
1831
1832 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
1833 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
1834 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
1835 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
1836
1837 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
1838 defined macros.
1839
1840 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
1841 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
1842 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
1843 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
1844 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
1845 for more commands.
1846
1847 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
1848 the keyboard macro ring.
1849
1850 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
1851 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
1852
1853 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
1854 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
1855 this behaviour via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
1856 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
1857
1858 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
1859 C-x C-k SPC will step through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
1860 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
1861
1862 ---
1863 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
1864 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
1865 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
1866 C-c C-i b, and so on.
1867
1868 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1869
1870 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
1871 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
1872 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
1873 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
1874 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
1875 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
1876
1877 +++
1878 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1879
1880 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
1881 Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1882 type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1883 available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
1884
1885 +++
1886 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
1887
1888 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
1889 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
1890 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
1891 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
1892 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
1893 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
1894 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
1895 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
1896 `rsync' to do the copying).
1897
1898 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
1899 `su' and `sudo'.
1900
1901 ---
1902 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
1903 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
1904 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
1905 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
1906 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method may
1907 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
1908
1909 ---
1910 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
1911 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
1912 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
1913 settings.
1914
1915 ---
1916 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
1917 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
1918 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
1919 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
1920
1921 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
1922
1923 ---
1924 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
1925 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
1926
1927 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
1928 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
1929 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
1930 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
1931 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
1932 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
1933
1934 +++
1935 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
1936 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
1937 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
1938 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
1939
1940 ---
1941 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
1942 Emacs will still work on terminals that require magic cookies in order
1943 to use standout mode, however they will not be able to display
1944 mode-lines in inverse-video.
1945
1946 ---
1947 ** cplus-md.el has been removed to avoid problems with Custom.
1948
1949 ** New package benchmark.el contains simple support for convenient
1950 timing measurements of code (including the garbage collection component).
1951
1952 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
1953 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
1954 in Indented-Text mode.
1955
1956 ** If you set `query-replace-skip-read-only' non-nil,
1957 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
1958 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
1959
1960 ** The new Lisp library fringe.el controls the apperance of fringes.
1961
1962 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
1963 configuration files.
1964 \f
1965 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.4
1966
1967 ** New functions posn-at-point and posn-at-x-y returns
1968 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
1969 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
1970
1971 ** Function pos-visible-in-window-p now returns the pixel coordinates
1972 and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
1973 arg is non-nil.
1974
1975 ** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
1976
1977 ** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
1978 supported on text terminals.
1979
1980 ** Support for displaying image slices
1981
1982 *** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) may be used with
1983 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
1984
1985 *** Function insert-image has new optional fourth arg to
1986 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
1987
1988 *** New function insert-sliced-image inserts a given image as a
1989 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
1990
1991 ** New line-height and line-spacing properties for newline characters
1992
1993 A newline may now have line-height and line-spacing text properties that
1994 control the height of the corresponding display row.
1995
1996 If the line-height property value is 0, the newline does not
1997 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
1998 newline glyph is reduced. This can be used to tile small images or
1999 image slices without adding blank areas between the images.
2000
2001 If the line-height property value is a positive integer, the value
2002 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
2003 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
2004
2005 If the line-height property value is a float, the minimum line height
2006 is calculated by multiplying the height of the current face font by
2007 the given value.
2008
2009 If the line-height property value is t, the minimum line height is
2010 the height of the default frame font.
2011
2012 If the line-spacing property value is an integer, the value is used as
2013 additional space to put after the display line; this overrides the
2014 default frame line-spacing and any buffer local value of the
2015 line-spacing variable.
2016
2017 If the line-spacing property value is a float, the value is multiplied
2018 by the current height of the display row to determine the additional
2019 space to put after the display line.
2020
2021 ** Enhancements to stretch display properties
2022
2023 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
2024 PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
2025 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
2026
2027 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
2028 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
2029 are supported:
2030
2031 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
2032 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
2033 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
2034 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
2035 | scroll-bar | text
2036 POS ::= left | center | right
2037 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
2038 OP ::= + | -
2039
2040 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
2041 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
2042 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
2043 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
2044 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
2045 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
2046 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
2047 the image.
2048
2049 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
2050 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
2051 corresponding area of the window.
2052
2053 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
2054 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
2055 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
2056 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
2057 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
2058 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
2059 these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
2060 the width of the area.
2061
2062 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
2063 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
2064
2065 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
2066 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
2067 header-line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
2068
2069 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
2070 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
2071 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
2072 height) of the specified image.
2073
2074 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
2075 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
2076
2077 ** New macro with-local-quit temporarily sets inhibit-quit to nil for use
2078 around potentially blocking or long-running code in timers
2079 and post-command-hooks.
2080
2081 +++
2082 ** New face attribute `min-colors' can be used to tailor the face color
2083 to the number of colors supported by a display, and define the
2084 foreground and background colors accordingly so that they look best on
2085 a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This is now the
2086 preferred method for defining default faces in a way that makes a good
2087 use of the capabilities of the display.
2088
2089 ** New function 'define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to change the
2090 built-in fringe bitmaps, as well as create new fringe bitmaps.
2091 The return value is a number identifying the new fringe bitmap.
2092
2093 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and identify the
2094 bitmap to change with the value of the corresponding symbol, like
2095 `left-truncation-fringe-bitmap' or `continued-line-fringe-bitmap'.
2096
2097 ** New function 'destroy-fringe-bitmap' may be used to destroy a
2098 previously created bitmap, or restore a built-in bitmap.
2099
2100 ** New function 'set-fringe-bitmap-face' can now be used to set a
2101 specific face to be used for a specific fringe bitmap. Normally,
2102 this should be a face derived from the `fringe' face, specifying
2103 the foreground color as the desired color of the bitmap.
2104
2105 ** There are new display properties, left-fringe and right-fringe,
2106 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
2107 bitmap of the display line.
2108
2109 Format is 'display '(left-fringe BITMAP [FACE]), where BITMAP is a
2110 number identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or as returned by
2111 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
2112 for displaying the bitmap.
2113
2114 ** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns a cons (LEFT . RIGHT)
2115 identifying the current fringe bitmaps in the display line at a given
2116 buffer position. A nil value means no bitmap.
2117
2118 ** Multiple overlay arrows can now be defined and managed via the new
2119 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'. It contains a list of
2120 varibles which contain overlay arrow position markers, including
2121 the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
2122
2123 Each variable on this list may have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
2124 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
2125 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
2126 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
2127 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
2128 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
2129
2130 +++
2131 ** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns line number of current
2132 line in current buffer, or if optional buffer position is given, line
2133 number of corresponding line in current buffer.
2134
2135 ** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
2136 variable `sentence-end-without-space' which contains such characters
2137 that end a sentence without following spaces.
2138
2139 ** The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of
2140 the variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil,
2141 then this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
2142 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
2143 `sentence-end-without-space'.
2144
2145 +++
2146 ** The flags, width, and precision options for %-specifications in function
2147 `format' are now documented. Some flags that were accepted but not
2148 implemented (such as "*") are no longer accepted.
2149
2150 ** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
2151 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
2152 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
2153 if no expansion is done, which may be tested using `eq'.
2154
2155 +++
2156 ** New function `delete-dups' destructively removes `equal' duplicates
2157 from a list. Of several `equal' occurrences of an element in the list,
2158 the first one is kept.
2159
2160 +++
2161 ** `declare' is now a macro. This change was made mostly for
2162 documentation purposes and should have no real effect on Lisp code.
2163
2164 ** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
2165 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
2166 tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
2167 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
2168
2169 +++
2170 ** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
2171 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
2172 string. The old behavior is available if you call
2173 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
2174
2175 ** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
2176 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
2177 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
2178 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
2179 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
2180
2181 ** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
2182 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
2183 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
2184 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
2185 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
2186
2187 ** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
2188 :pointer image property.
2189
2190 ** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images may now be
2191 controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
2192
2193 ** Images may now have an associated image map via the :map property.
2194
2195 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
2196 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
2197 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1))) specifying the
2198 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
2199 A circle is a cons (circle . ((x0 . y0) . r)) specifying the center
2200 and the radius of the circle; r may be a float or integer.
2201 A polygon is a cons (poly . [x0 y0 x1 y1 ...]) where each pair in the
2202 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
2203
2204 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
2205 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
2206 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
2207 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
2208 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable 'void-area-text-pointer'
2209 for possible pointer shapes.
2210
2211 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
2212 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
2213 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
2214
2215 ** Mouse event enhancements:
2216
2217 *** Mouse clicks on fringes now generates left-fringe or right-fringes
2218 events, rather than a text area click event.
2219
2220 *** Mouse clicks in the left and right marginal areas now includes a
2221 sensible buffer position corresponding to the first character in the
2222 corresponding text row.
2223
2224 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
2225
2226 +++
2227 *** Mouse events now includes buffer position for all event types.
2228
2229 +++
2230 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
2231
2232 +++
2233 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
2234 text area).
2235
2236 +++
2237 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types.
2238
2239 +++
2240 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns actual glyph coordinates.
2241
2242 +++
2243 *** Mouse events may now include image object in addition to string object.
2244
2245 +++
2246 *** Mouse events include relative x and y pixel coordinates relative to
2247 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
2248
2249 +++
2250 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
2251 (image or character) clicked on.
2252
2253 +++
2254 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', and
2255 'posn-object-width-height' return the image or string object of a mouse
2256 click, the x and y pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner
2257 of that object, and the total width and height of that object.
2258
2259 ** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
2260 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
2261 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
2262 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
2263 forcing an explicit window update.
2264
2265 ** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
2266 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
2267
2268 +++
2269 ** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
2270 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
2271 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
2272 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
2273 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
2274
2275 +++
2276 ** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
2277
2278 +++
2279 ** If optional third argument APPEND to `add-to-list' is non-nil, a
2280 new element gets added at the end of the list instead of at the
2281 beginning. This change actually occurred in Emacs-21.1, but was not
2282 documented.
2283
2284 ** Major modes can define `eldoc-print-current-symbol-info-function'
2285 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
2286 the language.
2287
2288 ---
2289 ** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
2290 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
2291 parts, e.g. utf-16.
2292
2293 +++
2294 ** The argument to forward-word, backward-word, forward-to-indentation
2295 and backward-to-indentation is now optional, and defaults to 1.
2296
2297 +++
2298 ** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
2299 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
2300 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
2301
2302 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
2303 does that, this value may not be accurate.
2304
2305 +++
2306 ** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
2307 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
2308 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
2309 the mode line.
2310
2311 +++
2312 ** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
2313 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
2314
2315 +++
2316 ** The kill-buffer-hook is now permanent-local.
2317
2318 +++
2319 ** `select-window' takes an optional second argument `norecord', like
2320 `switch-to-buffer'.
2321
2322 +++
2323 ** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
2324 selected window without impacting the order of buffer-list.
2325
2326 +++
2327 ** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
2328 text-properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
2329 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
2330
2331 +++
2332 ** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
2333 in the keymap.
2334
2335 ---
2336 ** VC changes for backends:
2337 *** (vc-switches BACKEND OPERATION) is a new function for use by backends.
2338 *** The new `find-version' backend function replaces the `destfile'
2339 parameter of the `checkout' backend function.
2340 Old code still works thanks to a default `find-version' behavior that
2341 uses the old `destfile' parameter.
2342
2343 +++
2344 ** The new macro dynamic-completion-table supports using functions
2345 as a dynamic completion table.
2346
2347 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
2348
2349 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
2350 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
2351 completions. This alist may be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
2352 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
2353 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
2354 entered. dynamic-completion-table then computes the completion.
2355
2356 +++
2357 ** The new macro lazy-completion-table initializes a variable
2358 as a lazy completion table.
2359
2360 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
2361
2362 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
2363 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
2364 ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
2365 completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
2366 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
2367 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
2368
2369 +++
2370 ** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
2371
2372 +++
2373 ** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
2374 for all (existing and future) frames.
2375
2376 +++
2377 ** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
2378
2379 +++
2380 ** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
2381
2382 +++
2383 ** The macro `with-syntax-table' does not copy the table any more.
2384
2385 +++
2386 ** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
2387 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
2388 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
2389 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
2390 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
2391
2392 +++
2393 ** The function `number-sequence' returns a list of equally-separated
2394 numbers. For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9).
2395 By default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different separation
2396 as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns (1.5 3.5 5.5).
2397
2398 +++
2399 ** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
2400 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
2401 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
2402 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
2403
2404 ---
2405 ** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
2406 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
2407
2408 +++
2409 ** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character,
2410 unless it is followed by a `-' in a character constant (e.g. ?\s-A),
2411 in which case it is still interpreted as the super modifier.
2412 In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
2413
2414 +++
2415 ** New function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the multibyteness
2416 of a string given to a process's filter.
2417
2418 +++
2419 ** New function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns t if
2420 a string given to a process's filter is multibyte.
2421
2422 +++
2423 ** A filter function of a process is called with a multibyte string if
2424 the filter's multibyteness is t. That multibyteness is decided by the
2425 value of `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is
2426 created and can be changed later by `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
2427
2428 +++
2429 ** If a process's coding system is raw-text or no-conversion and its
2430 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
2431 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
2432 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
2433 which was not compatible with the behaviour of file reading.
2434
2435 +++
2436 ** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
2437 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
2438
2439 +++
2440 ** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
2441 on garbage collection.
2442
2443 +++
2444 ** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
2445 it is read from a file without decoding.
2446
2447 +++
2448 ** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
2449
2450 +++
2451 ** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
2452 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
2453 by calling `select-window'.
2454
2455 ---
2456 ** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
2457 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
2458 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
2459 need to have a name.
2460
2461 ** Byte compiler changes:
2462
2463 ---
2464 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
2465 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
2466 Emacs and XEmacs and may sometimes make the result significantly more
2467 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
2468 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
2469 you anything.
2470
2471 +++
2472 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
2473 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
2474 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
2475 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
2476 forms:
2477
2478 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
2479 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
2480
2481 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
2482 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
2483 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
2484 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
2485 macro expansion), but such tests may be nested. Note that `when' and
2486 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
2487
2488 +++
2489 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
2490 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
2491
2492 +++
2493 ** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
2494 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
2495 be inserted is translated through it.
2496
2497 +++
2498 ** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
2499 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
2500 current file redefined it).
2501
2502 +++
2503 ** New Lisp library testcover.el works with edebug to help you determine
2504 whether you've tested all your Lisp code. Function testcover-start
2505 instruments all functions in a given file. Then test your code. Function
2506 testcover-mark-all adds overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to
2507 show where coverage is lacking. Command testcover-next-mark (bind it to
2508 a key!) will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
2509
2510 *** Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely evaluated;
2511 a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same value. The red
2512 splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly complete their evaluation,
2513 such as `error'. The brown splotches are skipped for forms that are expected
2514 to always evaluate to the same value, such as (setq x 14).
2515
2516 *** For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to help
2517 out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a red splotch.
2518 It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does return. The macro 1value
2519 suppresses a brown splotch for its argument. This macro is a no-op except
2520 during test-coverage -- then it signals an error if the argument actually
2521 returns differing values.
2522
2523 +++
2524 ** New function unsafep returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly
2525 do anything dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be
2526 unsafe (calls dangerous function, alters global variable, etc).
2527
2528 +++
2529 ** The new variable `print-continuous-numbering', when non-nil, says
2530 that successive calls to print functions should use the same
2531 numberings for circular structure references. This is only relevant
2532 when `print-circle' is non-nil.
2533
2534 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
2535 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
2536
2537 +++
2538 ** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
2539 the scroll-bar-width frame parameter value is nil.
2540
2541 +++
2542 ** The new function copy-abbrev-table returns a new abbrev table that
2543 is a copy of a given abbrev table.
2544
2545 +++
2546 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
2547 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
2548 can start with this line:
2549
2550 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
2551
2552 +++
2553 ** A function's docstring can now hold the function's usage info on
2554 its last line. It should match the regexp "\n\n(fn.*)\\'".
2555
2556 ---
2557 ** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
2558 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
2559
2560 +++
2561 ** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional buffer
2562 argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted it defaults to
2563 the current buffer.
2564
2565 +++
2566 ** There is a new Warnings facility; see the functions `warn'
2567 and `display-warning'.
2568
2569 +++
2570 ** The functions all-completions and try-completion now accept lists
2571 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
2572 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
2573 exported to Lisp.
2574
2575 ---
2576 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
2577 much pure storage it will approximately need.
2578
2579 +++
2580 ** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
2581 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
2582 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
2583 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
2584
2585 ---
2586 ** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
2587 of one coding system from another coding system.
2588
2589 +++
2590 ** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
2591 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
2592 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
2593 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
2594 needed.
2595
2596 ---
2597 ** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
2598 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
2599 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
2600 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
2601 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
2602 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
2603
2604 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
2605 confirmation as before.
2606
2607 +++
2608 ** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
2609
2610 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
2611 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
2612 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
2613 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
2614
2615 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
2616 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
2617 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
2618 between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
2619 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
2620 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
2621
2622 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
2623 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
2624 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
2625 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
2626
2627 +++
2628 ** Per-window fringes settings
2629
2630 Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and position
2631 settings.
2632
2633 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
2634 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
2635 `set-window-fringes'.
2636
2637 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
2638 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
2639 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
2640 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
2641
2642 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
2643 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
2644 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
2645 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
2646 an update of the display margins.
2647
2648 +++
2649 ** Per-window vertical scroll-bar settings
2650
2651 Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
2652 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
2653
2654 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
2655 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
2656 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
2657 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
2658 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
2659 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
2660 of the display margins.
2661
2662 +++
2663 ** The function `set-window-buffer' now has an optional third argument
2664 KEEP-MARGINS which will preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
2665 and scroll-bar settings if non-nil.
2666
2667 +++
2668 ** Renamed file hooks to follow the convention:
2669 find-file-hooks to find-file-hook,
2670 find-file-not-found-hooks to find-file-not-found-functions,
2671 write-file-hooks to write-file-functions,
2672 write-contents-hooks to write-contents-functions.
2673 Marked local-write-file-hooks as obsolete (use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook').
2674
2675 +++
2676 ** The new variable `delete-frame-functions' replaces `delete-frame-hook'.
2677 It was renamed to follow the naming conventions for abnormal hooks. The old
2678 name remains available as an alias, but has been marked obsolete.
2679
2680 +++
2681 ** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
2682 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
2683 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
2684 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
2685 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
2686
2687 ---
2688 ** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by lisp code
2689 to override the internal read-file-name function.
2690
2691 +++
2692 ** The new function `read-directory-name' can be used instead of
2693 `read-file-name' to read a directory name; when used, completion
2694 will only show directories.
2695
2696 +++
2697 ** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
2698 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
2699 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
2700
2701 ---
2702 ** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
2703 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
2704 (require 'cl) when loaded.
2705
2706 +++
2707 ** The `defmacro' form may contain declarations specifying how to
2708 indent the macro in Lisp mode and how to debug it with Edebug. The
2709 syntax of defmacro has been extended to
2710
2711 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
2712
2713 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
2714 declaration specifiers supported are:
2715
2716 (indent INDENT)
2717 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
2718
2719 (edebug DEBUG)
2720 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
2721 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro.
2722
2723 +++
2724 ** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
2725
2726 This is an alternative to using defadvice or substitute-key-definition
2727 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
2728 binding and lookup functionality.
2729
2730 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
2731 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
2732 original command.
2733
2734 Example:
2735 Suppose that minor mode my-mode has defined the commands
2736 my-kill-line and my-kill-word, and it wants C-k (and any other key
2737 bound to kill-line) to run the command my-kill-line instead of
2738 kill-line, and likewise it wants to run my-kill-word instead of
2739 kill-word.
2740
2741 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
2742 command remapping allows you to directly map kill-line into
2743 my-kill-line and kill-word into my-kill-word through the minor mode
2744 map using define-key:
2745
2746 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
2747 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
2748
2749 Now, when my-mode is enabled, and the user enters C-k or M-d,
2750 the commands my-kill-line and my-kill-word are run.
2751
2752 Notice that only one level of remapping is supported. In the above
2753 example, this means that if my-kill-line is remapped to other-kill,
2754 then C-k still runs my-kill-line.
2755
2756 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
2757
2758 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
2759 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
2760 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
2761 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
2762
2763 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
2764 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
2765
2766 - key-binding now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
2767 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
2768
2769 - where-is-internal now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
2770 kill-line if my-mode is enabled), and the actual key binding for
2771 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
2772 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
2773 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns C-k for kill-line and
2774 <kill-line> for my-kill-line).
2775
2776 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
2777 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
2778 command was not remapped.
2779
2780 +++
2781 ** New variable emulation-mode-map-alists.
2782
2783 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
2784 keymap alist separate from minor-mode-map-alist by adding their keymap
2785 alist to this list.
2786
2787 +++
2788 ** Atomic change groups.
2789
2790 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
2791 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
2792 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
2793
2794 (atomic-change-group
2795 (insert foo)
2796 (delete-region x y))
2797
2798 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
2799 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
2800 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
2801 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
2802
2803 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
2804 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
2805
2806 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
2807 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
2808 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
2809 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
2810
2811 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
2812 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
2813 do this.
2814
2815 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
2816 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
2817 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
2818 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
2819
2820 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
2821 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
2822 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
2823 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
2824 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
2825 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
2826 twice.
2827
2828 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
2829 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
2830 returned values, like this:
2831
2832 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
2833 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
2834
2835 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
2836 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
2837 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
2838
2839 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
2840 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
2841 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
2842 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
2843 finished.
2844
2845 +++
2846 ** New variable char-property-alias-alist.
2847
2848 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
2849 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
2850 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
2851 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
2852
2853 +++
2854 ** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
2855
2856 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
2857 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
2858 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
2859 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
2860
2861 +++
2862 ** New function remove-list-of-text-properties.
2863
2864 The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties' is almost the same
2865 as `remove-text-properties'. The only difference is that it takes
2866 a list of property names as argument rather than a property list.
2867
2868 +++
2869 ** New function insert-for-yank.
2870
2871 This function normally works like `insert' but removes the text
2872 properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list. However, if the
2873 inserted text has a `yank-handler' text property on the first
2874 character of the string, the insertion of the text may be modified in
2875 a number of ways. See the description of `yank-handler' below.
2876
2877 +++
2878 ** New function insert-buffer-substring-as-yank.
2879
2880 This function works like `insert-buffer-substring', but removes the
2881 text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list.
2882
2883 +++
2884 ** New function insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
2885
2886 This function is like insert-buffer-substring, but removes all
2887 text properties from the inserted substring.
2888
2889 +++
2890 ** New `yank-handler' text property may be used to control how
2891 previously killed text on the kill-ring is reinserted.
2892
2893 The value of the yank-handler property must be a list with one to four
2894 elements with the following format:
2895 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
2896
2897 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
2898 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
2899 element on the kill-ring). If a yank-handler property is found,
2900 the normal behaviour of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
2901
2902 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
2903 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
2904 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
2905 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
2906 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
2907 rectangle.
2908 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
2909 yank-excluded-properties is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
2910 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
2911 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
2912 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
2913 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
2914 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
2915 FUNCTION may set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
2916
2917 *** The functions kill-new, kill-append, and kill-region now have an
2918 optional argument to specify the yank-handler text property to put on
2919 the killed text.
2920
2921 *** The function yank-pop will now use a non-nil value of the variable
2922 `yank-undo-function' (instead of delete-region) to undo the previous
2923 yank or yank-pop command (or a call to insert-for-yank). The function
2924 insert-for-yank automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
2925 element of the string argument's yank-handler text property if present.
2926
2927 +++
2928 ** New function display-supports-face-attributes-p may be used to test
2929 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
2930
2931 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
2932 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
2933 defined with defface.
2934
2935 +++
2936 ** face-attribute, face-foreground, face-background, and face-stipple now
2937 accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how face
2938 inheritance is used when determining the value of a face attribute.
2939
2940 +++
2941 ** New functions face-attribute-relative-p and merge-face-attribute
2942 help with handling relative face attributes.
2943
2944 +++
2945 ** Enhancements to process support
2946
2947 *** Function list-processes now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
2948 only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set are listed.
2949
2950 *** New set-process-query-on-exit-flag and process-query-on-exit-flag
2951 functions. The existing process-kill-without-query function is still
2952 supported, but new code should use the new functions.
2953
2954 *** Function signal-process now accepts a process object or process
2955 name in addition to a process id to identify the signalled process.
2956
2957 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
2958 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
2959
2960 The new functions process-get and process-put are used to access, add,
2961 and modify elements on this property list.
2962
2963 The new low-level functions process-plist and set-process-plist are
2964 used to access and replace the entire property list of a process.
2965
2966 ???
2967 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
2968
2969 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
2970 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
2971 very poor performance. This behaviour can be remedied to some extent
2972 by setting the new variable process-adaptive-read-buffering to a
2973 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
2974 from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
2975 emacs tries to read it.
2976
2977 +++
2978 ** Enhanced networking support.
2979
2980 *** There is a new `make-network-process' function which supports
2981 opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
2982 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
2983
2984 - A server is started using :server t arg.
2985 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
2986 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
2987 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
2988 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
2989 - The process' property list may be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
2990 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
2991 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
2992
2993 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
2994 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
2995
2996 *** Original open-network-stream is now emulated using make-network-process.
2997
2998 *** New function open-network-stream-nowait.
2999
3000 This function initiates a non-blocking connect and returns immediately
3001 without waiting for the connection to be established. It takes the
3002 filter and sentinel functions as arguments; when the non-blocking
3003 connect completes, the sentinel is called with a status string
3004 matching "open" or "failed".
3005
3006 *** New function open-network-stream-server.
3007
3008 This function creates a network server process for a TCP service.
3009 When a client connects to the specified service, a new subprocess
3010 is created to handle the new connection, and the sentinel function
3011 is called for the new process.
3012
3013 *** New functions process-datagram-address and set-process-datagram-address.
3014
3015 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
3016 and set the current address of the remote partner.
3017
3018 *** New function format-network-address.
3019
3020 This function reformats the lisp representation of a network address
3021 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
3022 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
3023 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
3024 string for other formatting options.
3025
3026 *** By default, the function process-contact still returns (HOST SERVICE)
3027 for a network process. Using the new optional KEY arg, the complete list
3028 of network process properties or a specific property can be selected.
3029
3030 Using :local and :remote as the KEY, the address of the local or
3031 remote end-point is returned. An Inet address is represented as a 5
3032 element vector, where the first 4 elements contain the IP address and
3033 the fifth is the port number.
3034
3035 *** Network processes can now be stopped and restarted with
3036 `stop-process' and `continue-process'. For a server process, no
3037 connections are accepted in the stopped state. For a client process,
3038 no input is received in the stopped state.
3039
3040 *** New function network-interface-list.
3041
3042 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
3043 current network addresses.
3044
3045 *** New function network-interface-info.
3046
3047 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
3048 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
3049
3050 +++
3051 ** New function copy-tree.
3052
3053 +++
3054 ** New function substring-no-properties.
3055
3056 +++
3057 ** New function minibuffer-selected-window.
3058
3059 +++
3060 ** New function `call-process-shell-command'.
3061
3062 ---
3063 ** The dummy function keys made by easymenu
3064 are now always lower case. If you specify the
3065 menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
3066 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
3067
3068 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for
3069 the bindings that were made with easymenu.
3070
3071 +++
3072 ** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional
3073 argument. If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks
3074 for a function that could be called with `call-interactively',
3075 and does not return t for keyboard macros.
3076
3077 ---
3078 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
3079 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
3080
3081 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
3082 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
3083 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
3084 commands.
3085
3086 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
3087 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
3088 SQL buffer.
3089
3090 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
3091 (function (lambda ()
3092 (master-mode t)
3093 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
3094 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
3095 (function (lambda ()
3096 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
3097
3098 +++
3099 ** File local variables.
3100
3101 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3102 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3103
3104 +++
3105 ** New function window-body-height.
3106
3107 This is like window-height but does not count the mode line
3108 or the header line.
3109
3110 +++
3111 ** New function format-mode-line.
3112
3113 This returns the mode-line or header-line of the selected (or a
3114 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
3115
3116 +++
3117 ** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3118
3119 These functions are like `plist-get' and `plist-put' except that they
3120 compare the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3121
3122 +++
3123 ** New function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu'
3124
3125 The `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' must not be used (as previously
3126 recommended) for making entries in the tool bar for local keymaps.
3127 Instead, use the function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu', which lets
3128 you specify the map to use as an argument.
3129
3130 +++
3131 ** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3132
3133 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3134 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3135 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3136
3137 +++
3138 ** You can now make a window as short as one line.
3139
3140 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
3141 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
3142 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
3143 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
3144 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
3145
3146 +++
3147 ** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
3148 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
3149 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
3150 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
3151
3152 +++
3153 ** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
3154 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
3155
3156 +++
3157 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3158 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3159 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
3160
3161 +++
3162 ** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
3163 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
3164 line.
3165
3166 ---
3167 ** Indentation of simple and extended loop forms has been added to the
3168 cl-indent package. The new user options
3169 `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation', `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and
3170 `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can be used to customize the
3171 indentation of keywords and forms in loop forms.
3172
3173 ---
3174 ** Indentation of backquoted forms has been made customizable in the
3175 cl-indent package. See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3176
3177 +++
3178 ** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
3179
3180 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
3181 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
3182 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
3183 now:
3184
3185 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
3186
3187 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
3188 the time it takes to convert the format.
3189
3190 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
3191 wasteful.
3192
3193 +++
3194 ** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
3195 over minor mode keymaps.
3196
3197 +++
3198 ** A hex escape in a string forces the string to be multibyte.
3199 An octal escape makes it unibyte.
3200
3201 +++
3202 ** At the end of a command, point moves out from within invisible
3203 text, in the same way it moves out from within text covered by an
3204 image or composition property.
3205
3206 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
3207 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
3208 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
3209 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
3210 post-command-hook and thus does not care about intermediate states.
3211
3212 +++
3213 ** field-beginning and field-end now accept an additional optional
3214 argument, LIMIT.
3215
3216 +++
3217 ** define-abbrev now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG. If
3218 non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means that
3219 it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the abbrevs.
3220 Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always specify this
3221 flag.
3222
3223 ---
3224 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3225
3226 ---
3227 ** The function insert-string is now obsolete.
3228
3229 ---
3230 ** The precedence of file-name-handlers has been changed.
3231 Instead of blindly choosing the first handler that matches,
3232 find-file-name-handler now gives precedence to a file-name handler
3233 that matches near the end of the file name. More specifically, the
3234 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen.
3235 In case of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
3236
3237 ---
3238 ** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
3239 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
3240 bindings of the parent keymap.
3241
3242 ---
3243 ** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
3244 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
3245 (see jit-lock-defer-contextually), then all of that text will
3246 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
3247 depends on text several lines further down (and when font-lock-multiline
3248 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
3249
3250 s{
3251 foo
3252 }{
3253 bar
3254 }e
3255
3256 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
3257 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a jit-lock-defer-multiline
3258 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
3259 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
3260
3261 ---
3262 ** describe-vector now takes a second argument `describer' which is
3263 called to print the entries' values. It defaults to `princ'.
3264
3265 ** defcustom and other custom declarations now use a default group
3266 (the last prior group defined in the same file) when no :group was given.
3267
3268 +++
3269 ** emacsserver now runs pre-command-hook and post-command-hook when
3270 it receives a request from emacsclient.
3271
3272 ---
3273 ** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
3274 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
3275 than 3 levels of nesting.
3276
3277 ---
3278 ** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
3279 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
3280 it in that buffer.
3281
3282 ---
3283 ** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
3284 properties from surrounding text.
3285
3286 +++
3287 ** New function `buffer-local-value'.
3288
3289 This function returns the buffer-local binding of VARIABLE (a symbol)
3290 in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not have a buffer-local binding in
3291 buffer BUFFER, it returns the default value of VARIABLE instead.
3292
3293 ---
3294 ** New function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3295 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3296 clone to the other.
3297
3298 +++
3299 ** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
3300 *** the FACENAME returned in font-lock-keywords can be a list
3301 of the form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set
3302 other properties than `face'.
3303 *** font-lock-extra-managed-props can be set to make sure those extra
3304 properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
3305
3306 ---
3307 ** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
3308 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
3309 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
3310 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
3311 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
3312
3313 +++
3314 ** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
3315 are used by define-derived-mode to make sure the mode hook for the
3316 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
3317
3318 +++
3319 ** define-minor-mode now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
3320 and simply passes them to defcustom, if applicable.
3321
3322 +++
3323 ** define-derived-mode by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
3324 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
3325
3326 +++
3327 ** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
3328 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
3329 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
3330
3331 +++
3332 ** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
3333 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
3334 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
3335
3336 +++
3337 ** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
3338 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
3339 accepts a float as UID parameter.
3340
3341 ---
3342 ** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
3343
3344 +++
3345 ** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in elisp files is now obeyed.
3346
3347 +++
3348 ** The Emacs Lisp byte-compiler now displays the actual line and
3349 character position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form
3350 of its warning and error messages have been brought more in line with
3351 the output of other GNU tools.
3352
3353 +++
3354 ** New functions `keymap-prompt' and `current-active-maps'.
3355
3356 ---
3357 ** New function `describe-buffer-bindings'.
3358
3359 +++
3360 ** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
3361 searching for an executable resp. an elisp file.
3362
3363 +++
3364 ** Variable aliases have been implemented:
3365
3366 *** defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3367
3368 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3369 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3370 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3371 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3372
3373 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3374 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3375
3376 *** indirect-variable VARIABLE
3377
3378 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3379 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3380 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3381
3382 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3383 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3384
3385 +++
3386 ** Functions from `post-gc-hook' are run at the end of garbage
3387 collection. The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
3388
3389 +++
3390 ** If the second argument to `copy-file' is the name of a directory,
3391 the file is copied to that directory instead of signaling an error.
3392
3393 +++
3394 ** The variables most-positive-fixnum and most-negative-fixnum
3395 hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3396
3397 ---
3398 ** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
3399 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
3400 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
3401
3402 ** Functions y-or-n-p, read-char, read-key-sequence and the like, that
3403 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
3404 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
3405
3406 ** New function x-send-client-message sends a client message when
3407 running under X.
3408
3409 ** New packages:
3410
3411 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
3412 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
3413 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
3414 state of your program. It separates the input/output of your program from
3415 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
3416 Emacs 21 such as the display margin for breakpoints, and the toolbar.
3417
3418 Use M-x gdba to start GDB-UI.
3419
3420 *** The new package syntax.el provides an efficient way to find the
3421 current syntactic context (as returned by parse-partial-sexp).
3422
3423 *** The new package bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
3424 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
3425 data structures.
3426
3427 *** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
3428 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
3429
3430 *** The new package button.el implements simple and fast `clickable buttons'
3431 in emacs buffers. `buttons' are much lighter-weight than the `widgets'
3432 implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that doesn't
3433 require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for such things
3434 as help and apropos buffers.
3435
3436 \f
3437 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
3438
3439 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
3440 been added.
3441
3442 \f
3443 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
3444
3445 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
3446 with Custom.
3447
3448 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
3449 as mule-utf-8. Coding system `utf-16-le-dos' is useful as the value
3450 of `selection-coding-system' in MS Windows, allowing you to paste
3451 multilingual text from the clipboard. Set it interactively with
3452 C-x RET x or in .emacs with `(set-selection-coding-system 'utf-16-le-dos)'.
3453
3454 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
3455 in UTF-8 locales).
3456
3457 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
3458 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
3459 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
3460 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
3461 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
3462 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
3463 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
3464 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
3465 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
3466 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
3467
3468 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
3469 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
3470
3471 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
3472 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
3473 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
3474 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behaviour is actually
3475 contrary to the compound text specification.
3476
3477 \f
3478 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
3479
3480 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
3481
3482 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
3483
3484 \f
3485 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
3486
3487 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
3488
3489 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
3490 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
3491 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
3492 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
3493 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
3494
3495 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
3496 were changed.
3497
3498 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
3499 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
3500
3501 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
3502 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
3503 instead of using default-major-mode.
3504
3505 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
3506 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
3507 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
3508 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
3509 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
3510 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
3511 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
3512
3513 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
3514 NEWS.
3515
3516 \f
3517 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
3518
3519 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
3520 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
3521 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
3522
3523 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
3524 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
3525
3526 \f
3527 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
3528
3529 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
3530 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
3531 charsets in this release.
3532
3533 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
3534
3535 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
3536
3537 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
3538 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
3539 to list them.
3540
3541 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
3542 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
3543 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
3544 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
3545 necessary changes to unexec.
3546
3547 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
3548 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
3549
3550 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
3551 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
3552
3553 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
3554 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
3555
3556 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
3557 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
3558 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
3559 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
3560 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
3561
3562 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
3563 new display features described below.
3564
3565 \f
3566 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
3567
3568 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
3569
3570 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
3571 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
3572 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
3573 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
3574 the text.
3575
3576 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
3577
3578 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
3579 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
3580 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
3581 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
3582 specify a font.
3583
3584 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
3585 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
3586 under Lisp changes, below.
3587
3588 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
3589
3590 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
3591 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
3592 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
3593 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
3594 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
3595 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
3596 on terminals.
3597
3598 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
3599 supported on character terminals.
3600
3601 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
3602 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
3603 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
3604 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
3605
3606 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
3607
3608 ** Sound support
3609
3610 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
3611 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
3612 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
3613 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
3614 sound support.
3615
3616 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
3617
3618 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
3619 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
3620 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
3621 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
3622
3623 - User option: max-mini-window-height
3624
3625 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
3626 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
3627 specifies a number of lines.
3628
3629 Default is 0.25.
3630
3631 - User option: resize-mini-windows
3632
3633 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
3634 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
3635 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
3636 again.
3637
3638 Default is `grow-only'.
3639
3640 ** LessTif support.
3641
3642 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
3643 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
3644
3645 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
3646
3647 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
3648 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
3649 non-nil.
3650
3651 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
3652
3653 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
3654 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
3655 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
3656
3657 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
3658
3659 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
3660 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
3661 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
3662 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
3663 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
3664 Emacs.
3665
3666 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
3667 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
3668 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
3669 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
3670 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
3671 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
3672
3673 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
3674 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
3675 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
3676 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
3677 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
3678 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
3679
3680 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
3681 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
3682 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
3683 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
3684 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
3685
3686 ** Tool bar support.
3687
3688 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
3689 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
3690 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
3691 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
3692 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
3693 icons will be used.
3694
3695 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
3696 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
3697
3698 ** Tooltips.
3699
3700 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
3701 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
3702 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
3703
3704 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
3705 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
3706 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
3707 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
3708
3709 ** Automatic Hscrolling
3710
3711 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
3712 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
3713 customized.
3714
3715 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
3716 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
3717 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
3718 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
3719 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
3720
3721 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
3722 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
3723 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
3724 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
3725 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
3726 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
3727
3728 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
3729 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
3730 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
3731 customizing face `fringe'.
3732
3733 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
3734 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
3735 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
3736 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
3737 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
3738 the window to be partially obscured.)
3739
3740 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
3741 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
3742 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
3743 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
3744
3745 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
3746
3747 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
3748 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
3749 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
3750 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
3751 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
3752 have enabled one.
3753
3754 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
3755
3756 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
3757
3758 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
3759
3760 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
3761 `*') toggles the status.
3762
3763 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
3764
3765 ** Hourglass pointer
3766
3767 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
3768 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
3769
3770 ** Blinking cursor
3771
3772 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
3773 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
3774 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
3775 the group `cursor'.
3776
3777 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
3778
3779 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
3780 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
3781 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
3782 details.
3783
3784 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
3785 have to do anything to activate it.
3786
3787 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
3788
3789 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
3790 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
3791
3792 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
3793 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
3794 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
3795 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
3796 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
3797 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
3798 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
3799 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
3800
3801 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
3802 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
3803 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
3804 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
3805 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
3806 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
3807
3808 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
3809 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
3810
3811 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
3812 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
3813 buffer by default.
3814
3815 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
3816 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
3817 beginning and end of the buffer.
3818
3819 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
3820 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
3821 signaled.
3822
3823 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
3824 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
3825
3826 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
3827 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
3828 this behavior.
3829
3830 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
3831 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
3832 Emacs dump core.
3833
3834 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
3835
3836 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
3837 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
3838 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
3839
3840 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
3841 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
3842 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
3843
3844 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
3845 using that menu.
3846
3847 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
3848
3849 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
3850 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
3851 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
3852 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
3853 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
3854 whitespace.
3855
3856 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
3857 all frames except the selected one.
3858
3859 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
3860 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
3861
3862 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
3863 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
3864 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
3865 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
3866 `Info-use-header-line'.
3867
3868 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
3869 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
3870 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
3871
3872 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
3873
3874 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
3875 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
3876 `fr-drdref.tex'.
3877
3878 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
3879 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
3880 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
3881 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
3882
3883 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
3884
3885 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
3886 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
3887 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
3888 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
3889
3890 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
3891 point in a pop-up window.
3892
3893 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
3894 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
3895 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
3896
3897 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
3898 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
3899
3900 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
3901 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
3902 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
3903 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
3904
3905 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
3906
3907 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
3908 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
3909
3910 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
3911 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
3912 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
3913
3914 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
3915 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
3916 non-nil.
3917
3918 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
3919 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
3920 file that is already visited under a different name.
3921
3922 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
3923 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
3924
3925 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
3926 and displays information about that.
3927
3928 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
3929 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
3930
3931 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
3932 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
3933 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
3934 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
3935 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
3936 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
3937
3938 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
3939 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
3940
3941 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
3942 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
3943 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
3944 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
3945 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
3946 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
3947 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
3948
3949 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
3950 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
3951
3952 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
3953 system for keyboard input.
3954
3955 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
3956 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
3957 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
3958 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
3959 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
3960 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
3961 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
3962 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
3963 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
3964
3965 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
3966 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
3967
3968 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
3969 displays all characters in that character set.
3970
3971 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
3972 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
3973
3974 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
3975 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
3976 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
3977
3978 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
3979 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
3980 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
3981 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
3982 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
3983 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
3984 and Polish `slash'.
3985
3986 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
3987 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
3988 of the tutorial.
3989
3990 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
3991 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
3992 Lisp Coding Convention".
3993
3994 new command old-binding
3995 --- ------- -----------
3996 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
3997 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
3998 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
3999
4000 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
4001 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
4002 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
4003
4004 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
4005 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
4006 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
4007 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
4008 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
4009 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
4010
4011 ** There are new Leim input methods.
4012 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
4013 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
4014 package.
4015
4016 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
4017 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
4018 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
4019 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
4020 "`", you must type "=q".
4021
4022 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
4023 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
4024 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
4025 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
4026 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
4027 on.
4028
4029 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
4030 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
4031 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
4032 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
4033
4034 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
4035 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
4036 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
4037 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
4038
4039 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
4040 on the display using several methods
4041
4042 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
4043 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
4044 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
4045
4046 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
4047 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
4048
4049 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
4050
4051 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
4052 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
4053
4054 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
4055 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
4056 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
4057 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
4058
4059 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
4060 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
4061 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
4062
4063 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
4064 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
4065
4066 ** New X resources recognized
4067
4068 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
4069 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
4070 is useful for debugging X problems.
4071
4072 Example:
4073
4074 emacs.synchronous: true
4075
4076 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
4077 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
4078 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
4079 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
4080 visual class names are
4081
4082 TrueColor
4083 PseudoColor
4084 DirectColor
4085 StaticColor
4086 GrayScale
4087 StaticGray
4088
4089 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
4090 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
4091 meaning.
4092
4093 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
4094 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
4095 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
4096 visual.
4097
4098 Example:
4099
4100 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
4101
4102 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
4103 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
4104 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
4105 resource values are `true' or `on'.
4106
4107 Example:
4108
4109 emacs.privateColormap: true
4110
4111 ** Faces and frame parameters.
4112
4113 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
4114 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
4115 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
4116 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
4117 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
4118 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
4119 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
4120
4121 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
4122 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
4123 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
4124 `default' face and vice versa.
4125
4126 ** New face `menu'.
4127
4128 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
4129
4130 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
4131
4132 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
4133 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
4134 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
4135 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
4136
4137 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
4138 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
4139 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
4140
4141 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
4142 `ScreenGamma'.
4143
4144 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
4145
4146 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
4147 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
4148 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
4149 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
4150
4151 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
4152
4153 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
4154
4155 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
4156
4157 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
4158 LessTif/Motif one.
4159
4160 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
4161 LessTif and Motif.
4162
4163 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
4164
4165 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
4166 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
4167 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
4168
4169 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
4170 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
4171
4172 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
4173 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
4174 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
4175
4176 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
4177
4178 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
4179 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
4180 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
4181 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
4182
4183 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
4184 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
4185 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
4186 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
4187
4188 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
4189 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
4190 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
4191 buffers.
4192
4193 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
4194
4195 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
4196 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
4197 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
4198
4199 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
4200 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
4201 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
4202 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
4203 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
4204 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
4205
4206 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
4207
4208 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
4209 notably at the end of lines.
4210
4211 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
4212 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
4213
4214 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
4215
4216 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
4217 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
4218
4219 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
4220 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
4221 after each match to get the replacement text.
4222
4223 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
4224 you edit the replacement string.
4225
4226 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
4227 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
4228 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
4229
4230 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
4231
4232 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
4233 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
4234
4235 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
4236 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
4237 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
4238 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
4239
4240 --
4241 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
4242 read mail from the menu etc.
4243
4244 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
4245 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
4246 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
4247 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
4248
4249 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
4250 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
4251
4252 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
4253 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
4254 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
4255 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
4256 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
4257 of Emacs.
4258
4259 ** Customize changes
4260
4261 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
4262 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
4263 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
4264 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
4265 earlier versions of Emacs.
4266
4267 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
4268 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
4269 default).
4270
4271 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
4272 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
4273 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
4274 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
4275 file.
4276
4277 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
4278 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
4279 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
4280 already in your init file.
4281
4282 ** New features in evaluation commands
4283
4284 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
4285 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
4286 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
4287 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
4288 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
4289
4290 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
4291 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
4292 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
4293 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
4294 printed).
4295
4296 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
4297 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
4298
4299 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
4300 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
4301
4302 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
4303 code when called with a prefix argument.
4304
4305 ** CC mode changes.
4306
4307 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
4308 current user setups (although it's believed that these
4309 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
4310 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
4311 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
4312 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
4313 release.
4314
4315 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
4316 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
4317 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
4318 confusion.
4319
4320 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
4321 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
4322 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
4323 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
4324
4325 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
4326 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
4327
4328 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
4329 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
4330
4331 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
4332 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
4333 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
4334 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
4335
4336 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
4337 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
4338 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
4339 earlier statement. An example:
4340
4341 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
4342 if (a[i])
4343 res += a[i]->offset;
4344 else
4345
4346 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
4347 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
4348 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
4349 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
4350 the preceding "if".
4351
4352 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
4353 by default.
4354
4355 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
4356 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
4357 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
4358 documentation or other natural language text.
4359
4360 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
4361 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
4362 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
4363 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
4364 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
4365 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
4366 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
4367
4368 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
4369 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
4370 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
4371 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
4372
4373 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
4374 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
4375 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
4376 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
4377 Pike mode only.
4378
4379 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
4380 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
4381 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
4382 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
4383 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
4384 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
4385 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
4386 is reported afterwards.
4387
4388 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
4389 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
4390 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
4391
4392 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
4393 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
4394 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
4395 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
4396 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
4397 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
4398 groundwork.
4399
4400 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
4401 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
4402 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
4403 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
4404 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
4405 have to bother.
4406
4407 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
4408 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
4409 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
4410 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
4411 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
4412 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
4413
4414 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
4415 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
4416 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
4417 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
4418 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
4419 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
4420 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
4421 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
4422
4423 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
4424 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
4425 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
4426 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
4427 above.
4428
4429 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
4430 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
4431 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
4432 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
4433 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
4434 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
4435 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
4436 function documentation for more info.
4437
4438 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
4439 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
4440 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
4441 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
4442 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
4443 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
4444 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
4445 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
4446
4447 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
4448
4449 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
4450 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
4451
4452 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
4453 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
4454 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
4455 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
4456 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
4457 style system.
4458
4459 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
4460 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
4461 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
4462 as far as possible.
4463
4464 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
4465 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
4466 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
4467 chapter about this in the manual.
4468
4469 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
4470 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
4471 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
4472 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
4473 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
4474
4475 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
4476 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
4477 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
4478
4479 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
4480 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
4481
4482 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
4483 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
4484 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
4485 inside CC Mode.
4486
4487 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
4488 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
4489 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
4490 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
4491 cc-mode/).
4492
4493 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
4494 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
4495 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
4496 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
4497 they were before the filling.
4498
4499 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
4500 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
4501 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
4502 literals.
4503
4504 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
4505 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
4506 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
4507 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
4508 this function.
4509
4510 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
4511 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
4512 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
4513 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
4514 Thanks to Eric Eide.
4515
4516 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
4517 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
4518 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
4519
4520 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
4521
4522 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
4523 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
4524 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
4525 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
4526
4527 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
4528 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
4529 the column specified by comment-column.
4530
4531 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
4532 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
4533 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
4534 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
4535 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
4536 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
4537
4538 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
4539 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
4540 arguments.
4541
4542 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
4543
4544 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
4545 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
4546 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
4547 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
4548 Provan).
4549
4550 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
4551
4552 ** Dired changes
4553
4554 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
4555 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
4556 is, delete only empty directories.
4557
4558 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
4559 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
4560 copy directories recursively.
4561
4562 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
4563 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
4564 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
4565
4566 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
4567 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
4568 directory.
4569
4570 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
4571 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
4572 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
4573 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
4574 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
4575
4576 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
4577 from ls switches.
4578
4579 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
4580 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
4581 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
4582 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
4583
4584 ** Gnus changes.
4585
4586 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
4587 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
4588 internationalization and mail-fetching.
4589
4590 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
4591 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
4592
4593 If you used procmail like in
4594
4595 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
4596 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
4597 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
4598 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
4599
4600 this now has changed to
4601
4602 (setq mail-sources
4603 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
4604 :suffix ".in")))
4605
4606 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
4607 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
4608
4609 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
4610 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
4611 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
4612 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
4613
4614 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
4615 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
4616 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
4617
4618 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
4619 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
4620 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
4621 now just a compatibility layer.
4622
4623 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
4624 Gnus facilities.
4625
4626 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
4627 called to position point.
4628
4629 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
4630 summary buffers and NOV files.
4631
4632 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
4633 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
4634
4635 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
4636 subtly different manner.
4637
4638 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
4639 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
4640 ever-changing layouts.
4641
4642 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
4643
4644 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
4645
4646 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
4647
4648 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
4649 macros
4650
4651 Key binding Macro
4652 -------------------------
4653 C-c C-c C-s @strong
4654 C-c C-c C-e @emph
4655 C-c C-c u @uref
4656 C-c C-c q @quotation
4657 C-c C-c m @email
4658 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
4659 M-RET @item
4660
4661 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
4662
4663 ** Changes in Outline mode.
4664
4665 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
4666 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
4667 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
4668
4669 ** Changes to Emacs Server
4670
4671 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
4672 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
4673 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
4674 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
4675 buffers to kill, as before.
4676
4677 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
4678 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
4679 this way.
4680
4681 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
4682 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
4683
4684 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
4685
4686 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
4687 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
4688 use. Default is 1000.
4689
4690 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
4691 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
4692
4693 ** Changes to hideshow.el
4694
4695 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
4696
4697 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
4698 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
4699 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
4700 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
4701
4702 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
4703 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
4704 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
4705 the open block.
4706
4707 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
4708 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
4709 the normal block-hiding function.
4710
4711 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
4712
4713 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
4714 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
4715 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
4716 for `hs-minor-mode'.
4717
4718 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
4719 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
4720
4721 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
4722
4723 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
4724 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
4725 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
4726
4727 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
4728 current buffer.
4729
4730 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
4731 in a log file.
4732
4733 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
4734 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
4735 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
4736 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
4737 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
4738 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
4739
4740 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
4741
4742 ** Changes to cmuscheme
4743
4744 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
4745 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
4746
4747 ** Changes in Font Lock
4748
4749 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
4750 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
4751
4752 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
4753 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
4754
4755 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
4756 the face used for each string/comment.
4757
4758 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
4759 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
4760
4761 ** Changes to Shell mode
4762
4763 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
4764 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
4765 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
4766 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
4767
4768 ** Comint (subshell) changes
4769
4770 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
4771 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
4772
4773 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
4774 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
4775 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
4776 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
4777 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
4778 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
4779
4780 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
4781 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
4782 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
4783 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
4784 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
4785 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
4786 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
4787 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
4788
4789 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
4790 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
4791
4792 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
4793 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
4794 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
4795
4796 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
4797 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
4798 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
4799
4800 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
4801 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
4802 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
4803
4804 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
4805 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
4806 argument, it appends to the file.
4807
4808 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
4809 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
4810 compatibility.
4811
4812 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
4813 ring (history).
4814
4815 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
4816 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
4817 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
4818
4819 ** Changes to Rmail mode
4820
4821 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
4822 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
4823 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
4824 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
4825 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
4826 as correspondent.
4827
4828 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
4829 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
4830 regexp matching your mail addresses.
4831
4832 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
4833 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
4834 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
4835 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
4836 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
4837
4838 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
4839 like `j'.
4840
4841 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
4842 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
4843 digest message.
4844
4845 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
4846 in which folder to put messages automatically.
4847
4848 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
4849 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
4850 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
4851
4852 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
4853 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
4854
4855 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
4856 use the -f option when sending mail.
4857
4858 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
4859 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
4860 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
4861 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
4862 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
4863 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
4864
4865 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
4866 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
4867 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
4868
4869 ** Changes to TeX mode
4870
4871 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
4872 `latex-mode'.
4873
4874 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
4875
4876 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
4877
4878 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
4879
4880 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
4881
4882 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
4883 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
4884 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
4885 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
4886 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
4887 can be edited from that buffer.
4888
4889 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
4890 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
4891 `A' to use all marked entries).
4892
4893 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
4894 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
4895
4896 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
4897 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
4898 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
4899 been cited.
4900
4901 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
4902 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
4903 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
4904 in column 1 are always made leaves.
4905
4906 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
4907 has the following new features:
4908
4909 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
4910 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
4911 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
4912 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
4913
4914 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
4915 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
4916 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
4917 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
4918 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
4919 defaults to 1.
4920
4921 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
4922 file names.
4923
4924 ** Ispell changes
4925
4926 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
4927 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
4928 spell-checks the current buffer.
4929
4930 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
4931 added.
4932
4933 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
4934 correction is made and re-checked.
4935
4936 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
4937
4938 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
4939 cases.
4940
4941 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
4942 on syntax errors.
4943
4944 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
4945 end of the buffer.
4946
4947 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
4948
4949 ** Makefile mode changes
4950
4951 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
4952
4953 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
4954 Fontlock mode is active.
4955
4956 ** Isearch changes
4957
4958 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
4959 so that searches can be resumed.
4960
4961 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
4962 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
4963 that started the search.
4964
4965 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
4966 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
4967
4968 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
4969
4970 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
4971 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
4972 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
4973 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
4974 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
4975 `secondary-selection'.
4976
4977 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
4978 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
4979 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
4980 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
4981 usual snappy response.
4982
4983 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
4984 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
4985 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
4986 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
4987
4988 ** VC Changes
4989
4990 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
4991 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
4992 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
4993 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
4994 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
4995 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
4996 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
4997 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
4998 file is registered in that backend.
4999
5000 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
5001 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
5002 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
5003 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
5004 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
5005 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
5006
5007 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
5008 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
5009 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
5010 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
5011 where it doesn't make sense.)
5012
5013 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
5014 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
5015 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
5016
5017 *** General Changes
5018
5019 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
5020 checks are always done now.
5021
5022 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
5023 operations.
5024
5025 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
5026 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
5027 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
5028
5029 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
5030 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
5031 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
5032 the working file (``merge news'').
5033
5034 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
5035 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
5036 downwards.
5037
5038 *** Multiple Backends
5039
5040 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
5041 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
5042 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
5043 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
5044 local RCS archives.
5045
5046 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
5047 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
5048 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
5049 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
5050
5051 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
5052 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
5053 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
5054 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
5055 current revision number from the more remote backend.
5056
5057 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
5058 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
5059 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
5060 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
5061
5062 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
5063 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
5064 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
5065 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
5066
5067 *** Changes for CVS
5068
5069 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
5070 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
5071 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
5072 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
5073 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
5074 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
5075 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
5076
5077 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
5078 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
5079 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
5080 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
5081 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
5082 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
5083 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
5084 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
5085 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
5086 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
5087 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
5088 name.)
5089
5090 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
5091 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
5092 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
5093 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
5094 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
5095 entire directory tree.
5096
5097 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
5098 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
5099 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
5100 "watched" by other developers.)
5101
5102 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
5103 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
5104 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
5105 starting at the given directory.
5106
5107 *** Lisp Changes in VC
5108
5109 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
5110 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
5111 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
5112 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
5113 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
5114 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
5115 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
5116 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
5117 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
5118
5119 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
5120 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
5121 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
5122 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
5123
5124 ** New modes and packages
5125
5126 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
5127 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
5128 the default is not applicable.
5129
5130 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
5131 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
5132 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
5133
5134 Features are:
5135
5136 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
5137 drawn, like this: | \ /
5138 --+-- X
5139 | / \
5140
5141 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
5142 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
5143 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
5144 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
5145 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
5146 you are drawing.
5147
5148 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
5149 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
5150
5151 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
5152 flood-filling.
5153
5154 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
5155 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
5156 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
5157 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
5158
5159 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
5160 also do without the mouse.
5161
5162 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
5163 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
5164 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
5165 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
5166 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
5167
5168 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
5169
5170 lines straight-lines
5171 rectangles squares
5172 poly-lines straight poly-lines
5173 ellipses circles
5174 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
5175 spray-can setting size for spraying
5176 vaporize line vaporize lines
5177 erase characters erase rectangles
5178
5179 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
5180 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
5181 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
5182 drawing.
5183
5184 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
5185 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
5186 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
5187 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
5188
5189 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
5190 can be turned off).
5191
5192 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
5193 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
5194 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
5195 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
5196 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
5197 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
5198 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
5199 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
5200 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
5201
5202 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
5203 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
5204 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
5205 on certain projects.
5206
5207 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
5208 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
5209
5210 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
5211
5212 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
5213 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
5214 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
5215 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
5216 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
5217 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
5218 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
5219 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
5220
5221 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
5222 Emacs is idle.
5223
5224 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
5225 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
5226
5227 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
5228 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
5229
5230 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
5231 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
5232 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
5233 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
5234 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
5235
5236 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
5237 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
5238 separate Texinfo file.
5239
5240 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
5241 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
5242 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
5243 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
5244 enter check-in log messages.
5245
5246 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
5247 without invoking external programs.
5248
5249 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
5250 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
5251 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
5252 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
5253 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
5254
5255 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
5256 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
5257
5258 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
5259 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
5260
5261 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
5262 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
5263 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
5264 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
5265 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
5266 single step.
5267
5268 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
5269 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
5270 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
5271 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
5272
5273 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
5274 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
5275 actually modifying content of a buffer.
5276
5277 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
5278 PostScript.
5279
5280 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
5281
5282 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
5283
5284 ; comment (until end of line)
5285 A non-terminal
5286 "C" terminal
5287 ?C? special
5288 $A default non-terminal
5289 $"C" default terminal
5290 $?C? default special
5291 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
5292 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
5293 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
5294 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
5295 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
5296 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
5297 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
5298 C+ one or more occurrences of C
5299 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
5300 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
5301 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
5302 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
5303 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
5304 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
5305 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
5306
5307 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
5308
5309 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
5310 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
5311 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
5312 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
5313 equal signs of assignments.
5314
5315 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
5316 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
5317
5318 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
5319 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
5320 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
5321
5322 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
5323
5324 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
5325 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
5326 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
5327 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
5328 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
5329 which answers different needs.
5330
5331 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
5332 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
5333 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
5334 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
5335 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
5336 to be enabled.
5337
5338 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
5339 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
5340
5341 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
5342
5343 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
5344 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
5345 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
5346
5347 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
5348
5349 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
5350 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
5351 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
5352 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
5353 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
5354 and background colors.
5355
5356 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
5357 Pascal) language.
5358
5359 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
5360 the text at point.
5361
5362 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
5363
5364 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
5365
5366 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
5367 whitespace in a file.
5368
5369 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
5370 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
5371 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
5372 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
5373 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
5374 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
5375 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
5376
5377 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
5378
5379 Here is an example of columns:
5380
5381 horse apple bus
5382 dog pineapple car EXTRA
5383 porcupine strawberry airplane
5384
5385 Doing the following settings:
5386
5387 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
5388 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
5389 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
5390 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
5391
5392
5393 Selecting the lines above and typing:
5394
5395 M-x delimit-columns-region
5396
5397 It results:
5398
5399 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
5400 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
5401 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
5402
5403 delim-col has the following options:
5404
5405 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
5406 before all columns.
5407
5408 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
5409 between each column.
5410
5411 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
5412 after all columns.
5413
5414 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
5415 each column.
5416
5417 delim-col has the following commands:
5418
5419 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
5420 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
5421
5422 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
5423 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
5424 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
5425 recent file list can be displayed:
5426
5427 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
5428 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
5429 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
5430
5431 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
5432 dynamically change the menu appearance.
5433
5434 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
5435 text.
5436
5437 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
5438 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
5439 specific to Message mode.
5440
5441 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
5442 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
5443 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
5444
5445 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
5446 interface to access directory servers using different directory
5447 protocols. It has a separate manual.
5448
5449 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
5450 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
5451
5452 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
5453
5454 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
5455 minibuffer with completion.
5456
5457 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
5458 with the diary features.
5459
5460 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
5461 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
5462
5463 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
5464 Fill mode.
5465
5466 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
5467 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
5468 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
5469 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
5470
5471 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
5472 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
5473 `.g'.
5474
5475 ** Changes in sort.el
5476
5477 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
5478 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
5479 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
5480 numeric base.
5481
5482 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
5483
5484 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
5485 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
5486 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
5487
5488 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
5489 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
5490
5491 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
5492 output ^M at the end of lines.
5493
5494 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
5495 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
5496
5497 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
5498 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
5499 `(msb-mode 1)'.
5500
5501 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
5502 group.
5503
5504 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
5505 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
5506 are recognized:
5507
5508 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
5509 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
5510 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
5511 nil -- just delete one character.
5512
5513 Default value is `untabify'.
5514
5515 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
5516
5517 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
5518 symbol, not double-quoted.
5519
5520 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
5521 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
5522 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
5523 moved to lisp/obsolete.
5524
5525 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
5526 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
5527 `auto-compression-mode' command.
5528
5529 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
5530 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
5531 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
5532
5533 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
5534 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
5535
5536 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
5537 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
5538
5539 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
5540 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
5541
5542 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
5543 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
5544 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
5545 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
5546 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
5547 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
5548
5549 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
5550 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
5551
5552 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
5553
5554 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
5555 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
5556
5557 ** Shell script mode changes.
5558
5559 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
5560 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
5561 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
5562
5563 ** Etags changes.
5564
5565 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
5566
5567 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
5568 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
5569 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
5570 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
5571 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
5572
5573 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
5574 declarations when given the --declarations option.
5575
5576 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
5577 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
5578
5579 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
5580 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
5581 `template' keywords.
5582
5583 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
5584 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
5585
5586 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
5587 types.
5588
5589 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
5590
5591 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
5592
5593 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
5594 are now tagged.
5595
5596 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
5597
5598 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
5599 variables are tagged.
5600
5601 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
5602
5603 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
5604 for PSWrap.
5605
5606 ** Changes in etags.el
5607
5608 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
5609 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
5610 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
5611
5612 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
5613 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
5614
5615 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
5616 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
5617 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
5618 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
5619
5620 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
5621
5622 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
5623 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
5624
5625 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
5626
5627 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
5628 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
5629 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
5630
5631 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
5632 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
5633
5634 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
5635 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
5636
5637 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
5638 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
5639 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
5640 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
5641 point will go to the beginning of the file.
5642
5643 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
5644 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
5645 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
5646
5647 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
5648 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
5649 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
5650
5651 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
5652 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
5653 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
5654
5655 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
5656
5657 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
5658
5659 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
5660 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
5661 expression from that list, are not checked.
5662
5663 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
5664 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
5665 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
5666 the buffer, just like for the local files.
5667
5668 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
5669
5670 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
5671 displays local abbrevs, only.
5672
5673 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
5674 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
5675
5676 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
5677 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
5678 is measured in pixels.
5679
5680 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
5681 to be visited as images.
5682
5683 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
5684 were added to compile.el.
5685
5686 ** Withdrawn packages
5687
5688 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
5689 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
5690
5691 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
5692
5693 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
5694
5695 \f
5696 * Incompatible Lisp changes
5697
5698 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
5699 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
5700 See the sections below for details.
5701
5702 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
5703 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
5704 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
5705 to remove the properties of the copy.
5706
5707 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
5708 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
5709 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
5710 these properties are active.
5711
5712 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
5713 ranges may affect some code.
5714
5715 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
5716 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
5717 make a difference to some code.
5718
5719 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
5720 operates on the minibuffer.
5721
5722 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
5723 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
5724 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
5725 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
5726 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
5727 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
5728 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
5729 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
5730 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
5731 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
5732 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
5733 the buffer as multibyte characters.
5734
5735 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
5736 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
5737 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
5738
5739 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
5740 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
5741 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
5742
5743 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
5744 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
5745 such as `mapconcat'.
5746
5747 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
5748 string.
5749
5750 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
5751 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
5752 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
5753 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
5754 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
5755 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
5756 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
5757 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
5758
5759 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
5760 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
5761 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
5762 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
5763 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
5764 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
5765 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
5766 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
5767 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
5768 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
5769
5770 \f
5771 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
5772 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
5773
5774 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
5775
5776 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
5777 allows the animated display of strings.
5778
5779 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
5780 interactive form of a function.
5781
5782 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
5783 between custom options. Example:
5784
5785 (defcustom default-input-method nil
5786 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
5787 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
5788 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
5789 :group 'mule
5790 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
5791 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
5792
5793 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
5794 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
5795 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
5796
5797 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
5798 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
5799 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
5800 (signal or normal termination).
5801
5802 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
5803 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
5804
5805 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
5806 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
5807
5808 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
5809 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
5810
5811 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
5812
5813 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
5814 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
5815 being deleted.
5816
5817 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
5818
5819 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
5820 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
5821 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
5822 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
5823 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
5824 charset.
5825
5826 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
5827 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
5828 message.
5829
5830 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
5831 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
5832
5833 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
5834 with the more general `:mask' property.
5835
5836 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
5837
5838 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
5839 backslash.
5840
5841 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
5842 is running in batch mode. For example,
5843
5844 (message "%s" (read t))
5845
5846 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
5847 to standard output.
5848
5849 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
5850 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
5851
5852 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
5853 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
5854 frame or window.
5855
5856 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
5857 were added
5858
5859 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
5860
5861 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
5862 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
5863
5864 - Function: remq ELT LIST
5865
5866 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
5867 comparison is done with `eq'.
5868
5869 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
5870
5871 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
5872 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
5873 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
5874
5875 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
5876 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
5877 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
5878
5879 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
5880 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
5881
5882 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
5883 function was declared obsolete.
5884
5885 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
5886 retained as an alias).
5887
5888 ** Easy-menu's :filter now works as in XEmacs.
5889 It takes the unconverted (i.e. XEmacs) form of the menu and the result
5890 is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
5891
5892 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
5893
5894 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
5895
5896 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
5897 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
5898 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
5899 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
5900 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
5901 means never include the minibuffer window.
5902
5903 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
5904
5905 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
5906
5907 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
5908
5909 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
5910 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
5911 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
5912 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
5913 returned.
5914
5915 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
5916 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
5917 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
5918 minibuffer even if it is active.
5919
5920 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
5921 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
5922 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
5923 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
5924 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
5925 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
5926
5927 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
5928 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
5929 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
5930 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
5931 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
5932 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
5933 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
5934
5935 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
5936 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
5937 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
5938
5939 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
5940 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
5941 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
5942 Default value is nil.
5943
5944 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
5945 meaning no limit.
5946
5947 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
5948 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
5949 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
5950
5951 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
5952 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
5953 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
5954
5955 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
5956 list of a primitive.
5957
5958 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
5959
5960 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
5961 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
5962 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
5963 than replacing the local map.
5964
5965 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
5966 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
5967 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
5968 instead.
5969
5970 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
5971
5972 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
5973 as promised long ago.
5974
5975 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
5976
5977 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
5978 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
5979 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
5980
5981 \f
5982 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
5983
5984 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
5985 regular expressions.
5986
5987 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
5988
5989 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
5990
5991 - Macro: rx SEXP
5992
5993 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
5994
5995 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
5996 notation.
5997
5998 STRING
5999 matches string STRING literally.
6000
6001 CHAR
6002 matches character CHAR literally.
6003
6004 `not-newline'
6005 matches any character except a newline.
6006 .
6007 `anything'
6008 matches any character
6009
6010 `(any SET)'
6011 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
6012 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
6013
6014 '(in SET)'
6015 like `any'.
6016
6017 `(not (any SET))'
6018 matches any character not in SET
6019
6020 `line-start'
6021 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
6022 in the text being matched
6023
6024 `line-end'
6025 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
6026
6027 `string-start'
6028 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
6029 string being matched against.
6030
6031 `string-end'
6032 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
6033 string being matched against.
6034
6035 `buffer-start'
6036 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
6037 buffer being matched against.
6038
6039 `buffer-end'
6040 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
6041 buffer being matched against.
6042
6043 `point'
6044 matches the empty string, but only at point.
6045
6046 `word-start'
6047 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
6048 word.
6049
6050 `word-end'
6051 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
6052
6053 `word-boundary'
6054 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
6055 word.
6056
6057 `(not word-boundary)'
6058 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
6059 word.
6060
6061 `digit'
6062 matches 0 through 9.
6063
6064 `control'
6065 matches ASCII control characters.
6066
6067 `hex-digit'
6068 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
6069
6070 `blank'
6071 matches space and tab only.
6072
6073 `graphic'
6074 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
6075 space, and DEL.
6076
6077 `printing'
6078 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
6079 and DEL.
6080
6081 `alphanumeric'
6082 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6083 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
6084
6085 `letter'
6086 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6087 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
6088
6089 `ascii'
6090 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
6091
6092 `nonascii'
6093 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
6094
6095 `lower'
6096 matches anything lower-case.
6097
6098 `upper'
6099 matches anything upper-case.
6100
6101 `punctuation'
6102 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6103 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
6104
6105 `space'
6106 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
6107
6108 `word'
6109 matches anything that has word syntax.
6110
6111 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
6112 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
6113 of the following symbols.
6114
6115 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
6116 `punctuation' (\\s.)
6117 `word' (\\sw)
6118 `symbol' (\\s_)
6119 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
6120 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
6121 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
6122 `string-quote' (\\s\")
6123 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
6124 `escape' (\\s\\)
6125 `character-quote' (\\s/)
6126 `comment-start' (\\s<)
6127 `comment-end' (\\s>)
6128
6129 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
6130 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
6131
6132 `(category CATEGORY)'
6133 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
6134 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
6135
6136 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
6137 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
6138 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
6139 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
6140 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
6141 `symbol' (\\c5)
6142 `digit' (\\c6)
6143 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
6144 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
6145 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
6146 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
6147 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
6148 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
6149 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
6150 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
6151 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
6152 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
6153 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
6154 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
6155 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
6156 `ascii' (\\ca)
6157 `arabic' (\\cb)
6158 `chinese' (\\cc)
6159 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
6160 `greek' (\\cg)
6161 `korean' (\\ch)
6162 `indian' (\\ci)
6163 `japanese' (\\cj)
6164 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
6165 `latin' (\\cl)
6166 `lao' (\\co)
6167 `tibetan' (\\cq)
6168 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
6169 `thai' (\\ct)
6170 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
6171 `hebrew' (\\cw)
6172 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
6173 `can-break' (\\c|)
6174
6175 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
6176 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
6177
6178 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6179 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
6180
6181 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6182 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
6183 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
6184
6185 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6186 another name for `submatch'.
6187
6188 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6189 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
6190 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
6191 regular expression.
6192
6193 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
6194 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
6195 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
6196 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
6197 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
6198
6199 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
6200 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
6201
6202 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
6203 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
6204
6205 `(0+ SEXP)'
6206 like `zero-or-more'.
6207
6208 `(* SEXP)'
6209 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
6210
6211 `(*? SEXP)'
6212 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
6213
6214 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
6215 matches one or more occurrences of A.
6216
6217 `(1+ SEXP)'
6218 like `one-or-more'.
6219
6220 `(+ SEXP)'
6221 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
6222
6223 `(+? SEXP)'
6224 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
6225
6226 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
6227 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
6228
6229 `(optional SEXP)'
6230 like `zero-or-one'.
6231
6232 `(? SEXP)'
6233 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
6234
6235 `(?? SEXP)'
6236 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
6237
6238 `(repeat N SEXP)'
6239 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
6240
6241 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
6242 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
6243
6244 `(eval FORM)'
6245 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
6246 `regexp-quote' it.
6247
6248 `(regexp REGEXP)'
6249 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
6250
6251 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
6252
6253 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
6254 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
6255 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
6256 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
6257
6258 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
6259 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
6260 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
6261 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
6262
6263 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
6264 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
6265 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
6266
6267 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
6268 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
6269 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
6270 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
6271 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
6272 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
6273 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
6274 eight-bit-graphic.
6275
6276 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
6277
6278 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
6279 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
6280 character set as previously.
6281
6282 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
6283 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
6284 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
6285
6286 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
6287 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
6288 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
6289 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
6290
6291 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
6292 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
6293
6294 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
6295 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
6296 "fontset-default".
6297
6298 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
6299 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
6300
6301 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
6302 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
6303 buffers and strings.
6304
6305 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
6306 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
6307 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
6308 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
6309 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
6310 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
6311 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
6312 also been deleted.
6313
6314 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
6315 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
6316 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
6317
6318 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
6319 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
6320 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
6321 may differ between buffer and string text.
6322
6323 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
6324 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
6325
6326 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
6327 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
6328 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
6329 `composition' from STRING.
6330
6331 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
6332 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
6333
6334 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
6335 obsolete.
6336
6337 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
6338 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
6339
6340 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
6341 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
6342 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
6343 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
6344
6345 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
6346 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
6347 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
6348 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
6349 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
6350 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
6351
6352 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
6353 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
6354 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
6355
6356 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
6357 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
6358 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
6359
6360 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
6361 have been introduced.
6362
6363 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
6364 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
6365 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
6366 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
6367 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
6368 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
6369 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
6370 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
6371 their multibyte equivalent.
6372
6373 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
6374 that offset in the file before writing.
6375
6376 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
6377 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
6378
6379 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
6380 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
6381 from which the command was issued.
6382
6383 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
6384 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
6385 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
6386 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
6387 operate on.
6388
6389 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
6390 to `window-buffer-height'.
6391
6392 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
6393
6394 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
6395 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
6396 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
6397
6398 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
6399 respectively.
6400
6401 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
6402 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
6403
6404 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
6405 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
6406 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
6407
6408 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
6409 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
6410 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
6411 is currently displayed in some window.
6412
6413 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
6414 argument function's results.
6415
6416 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
6417 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
6418 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
6419 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
6420 sequence).
6421
6422 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
6423 header in the list of headers passed to it.
6424
6425 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
6426 ignores differences in case and text representation.
6427
6428 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
6429 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
6430 as follows:
6431
6432 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
6433 nil don't display a cursor
6434 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
6435 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
6436 others display a box cursor.
6437
6438 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
6439 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
6440 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
6441 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
6442
6443 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
6444 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
6445 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
6446 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
6447
6448 Example:
6449
6450 (string-to-syntax "()")
6451 => (4 . 41)
6452
6453 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
6454 other than 10.
6455
6456 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
6457 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
6458
6459 #b1111
6460 => 15
6461 #b-1111
6462 => -15
6463
6464 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
6465
6466 #o666
6467 => 438
6468
6469 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
6470
6471 #xbeef
6472 => 48815
6473
6474 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
6475
6476 #2R-111
6477 => -7
6478 #25rah
6479 => 267
6480
6481 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
6482 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
6483 and isn't a string.
6484
6485 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
6486 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
6487 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
6488 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
6489
6490 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
6491
6492 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
6493 for a regexp in a string.
6494
6495 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
6496 `mouse-position-function'.
6497
6498 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
6499 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
6500
6501 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
6502 Keywords are now always considered constants.
6503
6504 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
6505 returns it.
6506
6507 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
6508 returned by function `recent-keys'.
6509
6510 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
6511 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
6512 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
6513 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
6514 mode.
6515
6516 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
6517 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
6518
6519 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
6520 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
6521 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
6522 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
6523 been performed."
6524
6525 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
6526 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
6527 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
6528 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
6529
6530 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
6531 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
6532 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
6533
6534 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
6535 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
6536 specified table.
6537
6538 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
6539
6540 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
6541 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
6542 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
6543 what BODY returns.
6544
6545 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
6546 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
6547 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
6548 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
6549 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
6550
6551 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
6552 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
6553
6554 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
6555 instead of being optional.
6556
6557 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
6558 modify read-only text.
6559
6560 ** New functions and variables for locales.
6561
6562 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
6563 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
6564 time functions like strftime. The new variables
6565 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
6566 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
6567
6568 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
6569 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
6570 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
6571 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
6572 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
6573 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
6574 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
6575
6576 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
6577 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
6578 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
6579 start sequences.
6580
6581 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
6582 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
6583
6584 ** New function `propertize'
6585
6586 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
6587 strings with text properties.
6588
6589 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
6590
6591 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
6592 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
6593 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
6594 specified value of that property. Example:
6595
6596 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
6597
6598 ** push and pop macros.
6599
6600 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
6601 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
6602 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
6603
6604 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
6605 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
6606 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
6607
6608 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
6609
6610 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
6611 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
6612
6613 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
6614 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
6615 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
6616 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
6617
6618 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
6619 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
6620 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
6621 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
6622
6623 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
6624 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
6625 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
6626 or a sign.
6627
6628 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
6629 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
6630 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
6631 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
6632 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
6633 space, and DEL.
6634 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
6635 and DEL.
6636 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
6637 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6638 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
6639 [:alpha:] matches letters.
6640 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6641 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
6642 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
6643 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
6644 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
6645 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
6646 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6647 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
6648 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
6649 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
6650 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
6651
6652 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
6653
6654 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
6655
6656 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
6657
6658 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
6659 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
6660
6661 :test TEST
6662
6663 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
6664 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
6665 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
6666
6667 :size SIZE
6668
6669 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
6670 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
6671
6672 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
6673
6674 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
6675 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
6676 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
6677 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
6678 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
6679
6680 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
6681
6682 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
6683 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
6684 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
6685
6686 :weakness WEAK
6687
6688 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
6689 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
6690 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
6691 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
6692 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
6693
6694 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
6695
6696 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
6697
6698 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
6699
6700 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
6701
6702 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
6703
6704 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
6705 values are shared.
6706
6707 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
6708
6709 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
6710
6711 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
6712
6713 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
6714
6715 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
6716
6717 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
6718
6719 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
6720
6721 Returns the size of TABLE.
6722
6723 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
6724
6725 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
6726
6727 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
6728
6729 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
6730
6731 - Function: clrhash TABLE
6732
6733 Clear TABLE.
6734
6735 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
6736
6737 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
6738 not found.
6739
6740 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
6741
6742 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
6743 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
6744
6745 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
6746
6747 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
6748
6749 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
6750
6751 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
6752 arguments KEY and VALUE.
6753
6754 - Function: sxhash OBJ
6755
6756 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
6757
6758 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
6759
6760 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
6761 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
6762 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
6763 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
6764 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
6765
6766 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
6767
6768 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
6769 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
6770 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
6771
6772 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
6773 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
6774
6775 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
6776 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
6777
6778 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
6779 (sxhash (upcase a)))
6780
6781 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
6782 'case-fold-string-hash))
6783
6784 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
6785
6786 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
6787
6788 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
6789 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
6790 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
6791
6792 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
6793
6794 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
6795 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
6796
6797 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
6798 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
6799 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
6800 is too short to reach that column.
6801
6802 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
6803 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
6804 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
6805 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
6806
6807 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
6808 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
6809 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
6810
6811 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
6812 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
6813
6814 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
6815 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
6816
6817 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
6818 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
6819 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
6820 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
6821 temporary-file-directory instead.
6822
6823 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
6824 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
6825 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
6826 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
6827
6828 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
6829 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
6830
6831 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
6832
6833 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
6834 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
6835 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
6836
6837 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
6838
6839 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
6840 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
6841 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
6842 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
6843 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
6844 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
6845
6846 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
6847 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
6848 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
6849 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
6850
6851 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
6852
6853 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
6854 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
6855 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
6856 result string.
6857
6858 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
6859 string where arguments appear in the result string.
6860
6861 Example:
6862
6863 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
6864 (s2 "world"))
6865 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
6866 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
6867 (format s1 s2))
6868
6869 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
6870
6871 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
6872
6873 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
6874 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
6875 argument in it.
6876
6877 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
6878 (arg "world"))
6879 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
6880 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
6881 (message msg arg))
6882
6883 ** Sound support
6884
6885 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
6886 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
6887
6888 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
6889 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
6890 to enable sound support.
6891
6892 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
6893 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
6894 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
6895 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
6896 sound to play, before playing the sound.
6897
6898 The following sound properties are supported:
6899
6900 - `:file FILE'
6901
6902 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
6903 searched relative to `data-directory'.
6904
6905 - `:data DATA'
6906
6907 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
6908 may be present, but not both.
6909
6910 - `:volume VOLUME'
6911
6912 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
6913 0..1. This property is optional.
6914
6915 - `:device DEVICE'
6916
6917 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
6918 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
6919
6920 Other properties are ignored.
6921
6922 An alternative interface is called as
6923 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
6924
6925 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
6926
6927 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
6928 a keyword symbol.
6929
6930 ** Changes to garbage collection
6931
6932 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
6933 of live and free strings.
6934
6935 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
6936 strings that have been consed so far.
6937
6938 \f
6939 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
6940 Lisp Manual
6941
6942 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
6943 mini-windows.
6944
6945 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
6946 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
6947 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
6948
6949 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
6950
6951 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
6952
6953 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
6954 image.
6955
6956 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
6957
6958 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
6959
6960 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
6961 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
6962 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
6963 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
6964 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
6965
6966 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
6967 has a mask bitmap.
6968
6969 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
6970
6971 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
6972 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
6973 or omitted means use the selected frame.
6974
6975 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
6976 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
6977
6978 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
6979 optional.
6980
6981 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
6982 below).
6983
6984 \f
6985 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
6986
6987 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
6988 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
6989
6990 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
6991 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
6992 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
6993 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
6994 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
6995 just display it black instead.
6996
6997 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
6998 a line like
6999
7000 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
7001
7002 in your `.emacs'.
7003
7004 ** New face implementation.
7005
7006 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
7007 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
7008
7009 *** New faces.
7010
7011 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
7012
7013 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
7014
7015 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
7016 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
7017
7018 3. Font height in 1/10pt
7019
7020 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
7021
7022 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
7023
7024 6. Foreground color.
7025
7026 7. Background color.
7027
7028 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
7029
7030 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
7031
7032 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
7033
7034 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
7035
7036 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
7037 color.
7038
7039 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
7040 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
7041
7042 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
7043 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
7044 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
7045 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
7046 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
7047 attributes mentioned above.
7048
7049 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
7050 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
7051 created frames.
7052
7053 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
7054 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
7055 `fully-specified'.
7056
7057 *** Face merging.
7058
7059 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
7060 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
7061 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
7062 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
7063 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
7064 results in a fully-specified face.
7065
7066 *** Face realization.
7067
7068 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
7069 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
7070 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
7071 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
7072 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
7073 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
7074
7075 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
7076 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
7077 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
7078 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
7079
7080 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
7081 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
7082 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
7083 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
7084 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
7085
7086 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
7087 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
7088 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
7089 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
7090 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
7091 Emacs.
7092
7093 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
7094 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
7095 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
7096 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
7097
7098 **** Clearing face caches.
7099
7100 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
7101 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
7102 unused fonts.
7103
7104 *** Font selection.
7105
7106 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
7107 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
7108 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
7109
7110 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
7111 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
7112 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
7113 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
7114 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
7115
7116 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
7117 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
7118 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
7119
7120 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
7121
7122 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
7123 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
7124 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
7125 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
7126 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
7127 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
7128 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
7129
7130 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
7131 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
7132 doesn't exist.
7133
7134 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
7135 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
7136 registry.
7137
7138 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
7139 slightly different.
7140
7141 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
7142
7143
7144 **** Scalable fonts
7145
7146 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
7147 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
7148 servers.
7149
7150 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
7151 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
7152 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
7153 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
7154 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
7155 that list. Example:
7156
7157 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
7158
7159 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
7160
7161 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
7162
7163 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
7164
7165 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
7166 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
7167 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
7168
7169 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
7170 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
7171 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
7172 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
7173 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
7174 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
7175 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
7176 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
7177 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
7178 of the face font sort order.
7179
7180 - Function: x-font-family-list
7181
7182 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
7183 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
7184 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
7185 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
7186
7187 - Variable: font-list-limit
7188
7189 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
7190 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
7191 matching font. The default is currently 100.
7192
7193 *** Setting face attributes.
7194
7195 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
7196 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
7197 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
7198 `face-attribute'.
7199
7200 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
7201 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
7202
7203 The following attributes are recognized:
7204
7205 `:family'
7206
7207 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
7208 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
7209 and `?' are allowed.
7210
7211 `:width'
7212
7213 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
7214 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
7215 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
7216 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
7217
7218 `:height'
7219
7220 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
7221 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
7222 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
7223 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
7224
7225 `:weight'
7226
7227 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
7228 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
7229 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
7230
7231 `:slant'
7232
7233 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
7234 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
7235 `reverse-oblique'.
7236
7237 `:foreground', `:background'
7238
7239 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
7240
7241 `:underline'
7242
7243 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
7244 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
7245 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
7246 don't underline.
7247
7248 `:overline'
7249
7250 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
7251 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
7252 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
7253 overline.
7254
7255 `:strike-through'
7256
7257 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
7258 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
7259 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
7260 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
7261
7262 `:box'
7263
7264 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
7265 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
7266 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
7267 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
7268 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
7269 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
7270 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
7271 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
7272 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
7273 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
7274 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
7275 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
7276 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
7277 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
7278 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
7279 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
7280 box.
7281
7282 `:inverse-video'
7283
7284 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
7285 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
7286
7287 `:stipple'
7288
7289 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
7290 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
7291 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
7292 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
7293 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
7294 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
7295
7296 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
7297 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
7298
7299 `:font'
7300
7301 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
7302 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
7303 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
7304 versions of Emacs.
7305
7306 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
7307 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
7308 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
7309
7310 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
7311 `defface'.
7312
7313 `:inherit'
7314
7315 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
7316 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
7317 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
7318
7319 *** Face attributes and X resources
7320
7321 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
7322 from X resources:
7323
7324 Face attribute X resource class
7325 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
7326 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
7327 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
7328 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
7329 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
7330 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
7331 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
7332 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
7333 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
7334 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
7335 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
7336 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
7337 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
7338 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
7339 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
7340 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
7341 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
7342 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
7343 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
7344 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
7345
7346 *** Text property `face'.
7347
7348 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
7349 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
7350 specification can be
7351
7352 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
7353
7354 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
7355 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
7356 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
7357 for face attribute names.
7358
7359 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
7360 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
7361 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
7362
7363 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
7364
7365 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
7366 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
7367 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
7368 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
7369 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
7370 used to clear the mapping table.
7371
7372 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
7373
7374 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
7375 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
7376 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
7377 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
7378 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
7379 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
7380 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
7381 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
7382 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
7383 modify their color-related behavior.
7384
7385 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
7386 any frame type.
7387
7388 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
7389
7390 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
7391 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
7392 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
7393 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
7394 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
7395 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
7396 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
7397 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
7398 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
7399
7400 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
7401 display can display image files.
7402
7403 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
7404
7405 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
7406 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
7407 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
7408 `Inviolable' option.
7409
7410 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
7411 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
7412 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
7413
7414 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
7415
7416 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
7417 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
7418 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
7419
7420 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
7421 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
7422 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
7423 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
7424 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
7425 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
7426 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
7427 functions.
7428
7429 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
7430 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
7431 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
7432
7433 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
7434
7435 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
7436
7437 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
7438
7439 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7440 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
7441 constrained position if that is different.
7442
7443 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
7444 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
7445 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
7446 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
7447 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
7448 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
7449 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
7450 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
7451 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
7452
7453 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
7454 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
7455 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
7456 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
7457 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
7458
7459 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
7460 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
7461
7462 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
7463
7464 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
7465
7466 Delete the field surrounding POS.
7467 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7468 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7469
7470 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
7471
7472 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
7473 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7474 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7475 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
7476 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
7477
7478 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
7479
7480 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
7481 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7482 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7483 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
7484 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
7485
7486 - Function: field-string &optional POS
7487
7488 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
7489 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7490 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7491
7492 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
7493
7494 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
7495 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
7496 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
7497
7498 ** Image support.
7499
7500 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
7501 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
7502 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
7503 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
7504
7505 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
7506 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
7507 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
7508 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
7509 area.
7510
7511 IMAGE is an image specification.
7512
7513 *** Image specifications
7514
7515 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
7516 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
7517 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
7518 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
7519 described below are ignored.
7520
7521 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
7522
7523 `:ascent ASCENT'
7524
7525 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
7526 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
7527 to use for its ascent.
7528
7529 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
7530 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
7531
7532 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
7533 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
7534 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
7535 overlays that apply to the image.
7536
7537 `:margin MARGIN'
7538
7539 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
7540 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
7541 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
7542
7543 `:relief RELIEF'
7544
7545 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
7546 around an image.
7547
7548 `:conversion ALGO'
7549
7550 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
7551
7552 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
7553 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
7554
7555 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
7556 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
7557 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
7558 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
7559 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
7560 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
7561 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
7562 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
7563 below.
7564
7565 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
7566 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
7567 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
7568
7569 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
7570 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
7571 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
7572 of the factors' absolute values.
7573
7574 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
7575
7576 (1 0 0
7577 0 0 0
7578 9 9 -1)
7579
7580 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
7581
7582 ( 2 -1 0
7583 -1 0 1
7584 0 1 -2)
7585
7586 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
7587 ``disabled''.
7588
7589 `:mask MASK'
7590
7591 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
7592 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
7593 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
7594 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
7595 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
7596 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
7597 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
7598 image.
7599
7600 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
7601 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
7602 `:mask nil'.
7603
7604 `:file FILE'
7605
7606 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
7607 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
7608 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
7609 may be present in the image specification.
7610
7611 `:data DATA'
7612
7613 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
7614 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
7615 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
7616 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
7617
7618 *** Supported image types
7619
7620 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
7621
7622 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
7623 properties supported are:
7624
7625 `:foreground FG'
7626
7627 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
7628 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
7629
7630 `:background BG'
7631
7632 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
7633 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
7634
7635 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
7636 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
7637 instead of a `:file' property.
7638
7639 `:width WIDTH'
7640
7641 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
7642
7643 `:height HEIGHT'
7644
7645 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
7646
7647 `:data DATA'
7648
7649 DATA must be either
7650
7651 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
7652 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
7653
7654 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
7655
7656 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
7657 bitmap.
7658
7659 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
7660 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
7661 in the file.
7662
7663 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
7664
7665 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
7666 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
7667 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
7668 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
7669
7670 Additional image properties supported are:
7671
7672 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
7673
7674 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
7675 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
7676 name.
7677
7678 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
7679 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
7680
7681 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
7682 to display compressed images.
7683
7684 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
7685
7686 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
7687 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
7688 mono images are:
7689
7690 `:foreground FG'
7691
7692 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
7693 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
7694
7695 `:background FG'
7696
7697 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
7698 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
7699
7700 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
7701
7702 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
7703 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
7704 properties defined.
7705
7706 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
7707
7708 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
7709 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
7710 properties defined.
7711
7712 **** GIF, image type `gif'
7713
7714 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
7715 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
7716
7717 Additional image properties supported are:
7718
7719 `:index INDEX'
7720
7721 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
7722 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
7723 as a hollow box.
7724
7725 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
7726 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
7727 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
7728 every 0.1 seconds.
7729
7730 (defun show-anim (file max)
7731 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
7732 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
7733
7734 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
7735 (when (= idx max)
7736 (setq idx 0))
7737 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
7738 (save-excursion
7739 (set-buffer buffer)
7740 (goto-char (point-min))
7741 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
7742 (insert-image img "x"))
7743 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
7744
7745 **** PNG, image type `png'
7746
7747 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
7748 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
7749 properties defined.
7750
7751 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
7752
7753 Additional image properties supported are:
7754
7755 `:pt-width WIDTH'
7756
7757 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
7758 integer. This is a required property.
7759
7760 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
7761
7762 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
7763 must be a integer. This is an required property.
7764
7765 `:bounding-box BOX'
7766
7767 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
7768 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
7769 files. This is an required property.
7770
7771 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
7772 lisp/gs.el.
7773
7774 *** Lisp interface.
7775
7776 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
7777 which are supported in the current configuration.
7778
7779 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
7780 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
7781 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
7782 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
7783 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
7784
7785 *** Simplified image API, image.el
7786
7787 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
7788 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
7789 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
7790 define an image based on available image types. The functions
7791 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
7792 buffer.
7793
7794 ** Display margins.
7795
7796 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
7797 and images.
7798
7799 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
7800 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
7801 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
7802 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
7803 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
7804 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
7805 of the display margins.
7806
7807 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
7808 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
7809 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
7810 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
7811 in this file).
7812
7813 ** Help display
7814
7815 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
7816 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
7817 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
7818 that have a `help-echo' property.
7819
7820 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
7821 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
7822 the window in which the help was found.
7823
7824 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
7825 `help-echo' text property was found.
7826
7827 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
7828 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
7829
7830 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
7831 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
7832 mouse.
7833
7834 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
7835 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
7836
7837 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
7838 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
7839 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
7840 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
7841 used as help string.
7842
7843 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
7844 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
7845 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
7846
7847 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
7848
7849 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
7850 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
7851
7852 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
7853 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
7854 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
7855 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
7856 used.
7857
7858 (global-set-key [A-down]
7859 #'(lambda ()
7860 (interactive)
7861 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
7862 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
7863 (global-set-key [A-up]
7864 #'(lambda ()
7865 (interactive)
7866 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
7867 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
7868
7869 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
7870
7871 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
7872 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
7873 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
7874 is called with one argument, POS.
7875
7876 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
7877 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
7878 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
7879 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
7880 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
7881
7882 ** Tool bar support.
7883
7884 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
7885 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
7886 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
7887 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
7888 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
7889 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
7890
7891 *** Tool bar item definitions
7892
7893 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
7894 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
7895 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
7896
7897 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
7898 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
7899 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
7900 property (see below).
7901
7902 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
7903 binding are currently ignored.
7904
7905 The following properties are recognized:
7906
7907 `:enable FORM'.
7908
7909 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
7910 or disabled.
7911
7912 `:visible FORM'
7913
7914 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
7915
7916 `:filter FUNCTION'
7917
7918 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
7919 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
7920 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
7921
7922 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
7923
7924 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
7925 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
7926
7927 `:image IMAGES'
7928
7929 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
7930 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
7931 meaning of each of the four elements:
7932
7933 Index Use when item is
7934 ----------------------------------------
7935 0 enabled and selected
7936 1 enabled and deselected
7937 2 disabled and selected
7938 3 disabled and deselected
7939
7940 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
7941 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
7942
7943 `:help HELP-STRING'.
7944
7945 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
7946 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
7947
7948 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
7949 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
7950 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
7951 menu bar.
7952
7953 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
7954 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
7955 buffer-locally to override the global map.
7956
7957 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
7958
7959 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
7960 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
7961 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
7962
7963 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
7964 raised when the mouse moves over them.
7965
7966 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
7967 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
7968 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
7969 vertical margins . Default is 1.
7970
7971 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
7972 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
7973
7974 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
7975
7976 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
7977 a tool bar item. If
7978
7979 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
7980 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
7981 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
7982
7983 is the original tool bar item definition, then
7984
7985 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
7986
7987 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
7988 item.
7989
7990 ** Mode line changes.
7991
7992 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
7993
7994 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
7995 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
7996 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
7997
7998 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
7999 a `local-map' text property.
8000
8001 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
8002 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
8003
8004 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
8005 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
8006 `local-map' property.
8007
8008 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
8009 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
8010 example.
8011
8012 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
8013 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
8014
8015 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
8016 variable mode-line-format to nil.
8017
8018 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
8019
8020 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
8021 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
8022 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
8023 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
8024 line.
8025
8026 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
8027 `header-line'.
8028
8029 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
8030 position in the header-line.
8031
8032 ** Text property `display'
8033
8034 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
8035 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
8036 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
8037 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
8038 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
8039
8040 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
8041
8042 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
8043 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
8044
8045 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
8046 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
8047 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
8048 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
8049 simpler form STRING as property value.
8050
8051 *** Variable width and height spaces
8052
8053 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
8054 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
8055 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
8056 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
8057 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
8058 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
8059 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
8060
8061 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
8062 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
8063 properties described below.
8064
8065 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
8066 characters having the `display' property.
8067
8068 - :width WIDTH
8069
8070 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
8071 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
8072
8073 - :relative-width FACTOR
8074
8075 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
8076 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
8077 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
8078 width of that character by FACTOR.
8079
8080 - :align-to HPOS
8081
8082 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
8083 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
8084
8085 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
8086
8087 - :height HEIGHT
8088
8089 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
8090 normal line height.
8091
8092 - :relative-height FACTOR
8093
8094 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
8095 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
8096
8097 - :ascent ASCENT
8098
8099 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
8100 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
8101 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
8102 equal to 100.
8103
8104 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
8105
8106 *** Images
8107
8108 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
8109 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
8110 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
8111 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
8112 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
8113 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
8114 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
8115 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
8116 as display specification.
8117
8118 *** Other display properties
8119
8120 - (space-width FACTOR)
8121
8122 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
8123 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
8124 integer or float.
8125
8126 - (height HEIGHT)
8127
8128 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
8129
8130 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
8131 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
8132 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
8133 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
8134 a font is available counts as a step.
8135
8136 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
8137 as tall as the frame's default font.
8138
8139 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
8140 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
8141
8142 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
8143 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
8144
8145 - (raise FACTOR)
8146
8147 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
8148 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
8149 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
8150 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
8151 `height' subproperty.
8152
8153 *** Conditional display properties
8154
8155 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
8156 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
8157 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
8158 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
8159 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
8160 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
8161 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
8162 different when object is a string.
8163
8164 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
8165 `(when t . SPEC)'.
8166
8167 ** New menu separator types.
8168
8169 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
8170 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
8171 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
8172 to specify other menu separator types.
8173
8174 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
8175
8176 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
8177 separator occurs.
8178
8179 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
8180
8181 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
8182
8183 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
8184
8185 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
8186
8187 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
8188
8189 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
8190
8191 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
8192
8193 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
8194
8195 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
8196
8197 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
8198 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
8199
8200 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
8201
8202 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
8203
8204 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
8205
8206 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
8207
8208 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
8209
8210 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
8211
8212 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
8213
8214 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
8215
8216 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
8217
8218 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
8219
8220 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
8221
8222 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
8223
8224 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
8225
8226 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
8227
8228 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
8229 the corresponding single-line separators.
8230
8231 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
8232
8233 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
8234 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
8235 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
8236 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
8237 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
8238 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
8239 default foreground is black.
8240
8241 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
8242 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
8243 `ScrollBarBackground').
8244
8245 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
8246 settings for scroll bar colors.
8247
8248 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
8249 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
8250
8251 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
8252 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
8253 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
8254 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
8255 the original window start.
8256
8257 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
8258 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
8259 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
8260
8261 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
8262
8263 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
8264 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
8265 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
8266 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
8267
8268 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
8269 fixed-width and fixed-height.
8270
8271 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
8272
8273 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
8274 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
8275 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
8276 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
8277 temporarily to nil, for example
8278
8279 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
8280 (enlarge-window 10))
8281
8282 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
8283 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
8284
8285 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
8286 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
8287 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
8288 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
8289 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
8290 support a vertical-bar cursor).
8291
8292
8293 \f
8294 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
8295
8296 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
8297 input.
8298
8299 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
8300
8301 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
8302
8303 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
8304 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
8305 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
8306 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
8307 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
8308
8309 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
8310 been added.
8311
8312 \f
8313 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
8314
8315 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
8316
8317
8318 \f
8319 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
8320
8321 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
8322 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
8323 \f
8324 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
8325
8326 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
8327
8328 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
8329 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
8330 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
8331
8332 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
8333 is the one that is used.
8334
8335 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
8336 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
8337 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
8338 separate from the command's regular output.
8339 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
8340 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
8341 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
8342 the buffer name.
8343
8344 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
8345 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
8346 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
8347 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
8348
8349 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
8350 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
8351 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
8352 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
8353
8354 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
8355 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
8356 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
8357 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
8358
8359 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
8360 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
8361 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
8362 they never ignore case.
8363
8364 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
8365 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
8366 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
8367 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
8368 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
8369 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
8370 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
8371
8372 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
8373 the same format that was used in the file before.
8374
8375 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
8376 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
8377
8378 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
8379 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
8380 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
8381
8382 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
8383 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
8384 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
8385 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
8386 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
8387 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
8388 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
8389
8390 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
8391 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
8392 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
8393 format. You can now customize these variables.
8394
8395 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
8396 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
8397 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
8398 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
8399
8400 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
8401 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
8402 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
8403
8404 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
8405 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
8406 doesn't have any effect.
8407
8408 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
8409 not one per buffer.
8410
8411 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
8412 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
8413 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
8414
8415 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
8416 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
8417 `auto-show-mode' command.
8418
8419 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
8420 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
8421 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
8422 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
8423 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
8424
8425 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
8426 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
8427
8428 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
8429 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
8430 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
8431
8432 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
8433 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
8434 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
8435 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
8436
8437 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
8438
8439 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
8440 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
8441 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
8442 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
8443 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
8444
8445 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
8446 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
8447
8448 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
8449 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
8450 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
8451 `?' on other systems.
8452
8453 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
8454 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
8455 Unix.
8456
8457 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
8458 current codepage when it starts.
8459
8460 ** Mail changes
8461
8462 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
8463 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
8464 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
8465 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
8466 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
8467 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
8468 latin-1:
8469
8470 MIME-version: 1.0
8471 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
8472 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
8473
8474 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
8475 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
8476 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
8477 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
8478 buffer-file-coding-system.
8479
8480 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
8481 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
8482 mail.
8483
8484 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
8485 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
8486 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
8487 list of possible coding systems.
8488
8489 ** CC Mode changes
8490
8491 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
8492 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
8493 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
8494 docstring for details.
8495
8496 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
8497 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
8498 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
8499 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
8500 lineup functions use this feature currently.
8501
8502 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
8503 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
8504
8505 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
8506 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
8507
8508 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
8509 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
8510 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
8511 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
8512 anonymous classes.
8513
8514 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
8515 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
8516
8517 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
8518 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
8519 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
8520 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
8521
8522 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
8523 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
8524 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
8525 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
8526 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
8527
8528 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
8529
8530 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
8531
8532 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
8533 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
8534
8535 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
8536
8537 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
8538 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
8539 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
8540 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
8541 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
8542
8543 ** Gnus changes.
8544
8545 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
8546 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
8547 Gnus manual for the full story.
8548
8549 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
8550 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
8551 group, which is created automatically.
8552
8553 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
8554 values.
8555
8556 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
8557
8558 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
8559 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
8560
8561 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
8562 `C-u C-c C-c'.
8563
8564 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
8565
8566 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
8567 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
8568
8569 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
8570
8571 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
8572 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
8573
8574 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
8575 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
8576
8577 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
8578 control over simplification.
8579
8580 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
8581
8582 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
8583 limit.
8584
8585 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
8586
8587 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
8588
8589 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
8590 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
8591 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
8592
8593 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
8594 `a' forces normal posting method.
8595
8596 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
8597 -- `W d'.
8598
8599 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
8600 to a non-nil value.
8601
8602 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
8603 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
8604
8605 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
8606 has been added.
8607
8608 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
8609
8610 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
8611
8612 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
8613 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
8614
8615 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
8616 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
8617
8618 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
8619
8620 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
8621 been added.
8622
8623 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
8624 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
8625
8626 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
8627 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
8628
8629 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
8630
8631 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
8632
8633 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
8634
8635 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
8636
8637 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
8638 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
8639 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
8640
8641 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
8642 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
8643 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
8644 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
8645 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
8646
8647 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
8648 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
8649 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
8650 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
8651
8652 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
8653 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
8654 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
8655 mismatch.
8656
8657 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
8658
8659 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
8660 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
8661
8662 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
8663 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
8664 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
8665 removed from the label.
8666
8667 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
8668 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
8669
8670 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
8671 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
8672
8673 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
8674 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
8675 expressions.
8676
8677 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
8678
8679 ** New/deleted modes and packages
8680
8681 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
8682 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
8683
8684 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
8685 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
8686 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
8687
8688 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
8689 changes with a special face.
8690
8691 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
8692 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
8693 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
8694 \f
8695 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
8696
8697 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
8698 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
8699 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
8700 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
8701 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
8702
8703 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
8704 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
8705 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
8706
8707 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
8708 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
8709 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
8710 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
8711 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
8712 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
8713 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
8714 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
8715 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
8716
8717 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
8718 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
8719 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
8720 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
8721 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
8722 program.
8723
8724 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
8725 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
8726 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
8727 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
8728 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
8729 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
8730
8731 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
8732 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
8733 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
8734 was not documented clearly before.
8735
8736 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
8737 This includes Tetris and Snake.
8738 \f
8739 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
8740
8741 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
8742 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
8743 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
8744 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
8745
8746 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
8747 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
8748 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
8749
8750 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
8751
8752 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
8753 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
8754
8755 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
8756 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
8757 integers.
8758
8759 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
8760 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
8761 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
8762 file names and attributes are returned.
8763
8764 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
8765 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
8766 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
8767 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
8768 returns the result.
8769
8770 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
8771 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
8772
8773 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
8774
8775 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
8776 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
8777 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
8778 optionally.
8779
8780 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
8781 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
8782
8783 **
8784 The new function process-running-child-p
8785 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
8786 terminal to its own child process.
8787
8788 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
8789 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
8790 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
8791 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
8792
8793 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
8794 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
8795
8796 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
8797 :included is an alias for :visible.
8798
8799 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
8800 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
8801 to move or copy menu entries.
8802
8803 ** Multibyte editing changes
8804
8805 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
8806 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
8807 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
8808 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
8809 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
8810 (setq char (sref str idx)
8811 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
8812 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
8813
8814 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
8815 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
8816 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
8817
8818 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
8819 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
8820 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
8821
8822 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
8823
8824 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
8825 across the boundary.
8826
8827 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
8828 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
8829 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
8830 contains 8-bit characters.
8831 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
8832 contains invalid characters.
8833
8834 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
8835 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
8836 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
8837 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
8838 way.
8839
8840 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
8841 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
8842 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
8843 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
8844
8845 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
8846 compose Thai characters in a string.
8847
8848 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
8849 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
8850 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
8851 menus should always use the third argument.
8852
8853 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
8854 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
8855 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
8856 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
8857
8858 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
8859 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
8860 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
8861 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
8862
8863 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
8864 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
8865 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
8866 echo area contents.
8867
8868 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
8869
8870 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
8871 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
8872 requested feature cannot be loaded.
8873
8874 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
8875 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
8876 means to clear out that attribute.
8877
8878 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
8879 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
8880
8881 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
8882 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
8883 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
8884 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
8885
8886 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
8887 the gap of the current buffer.
8888
8889 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
8890 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
8891 current buffer.
8892
8893 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
8894 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
8895 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
8896 it back in after any modifications have been made.
8897 \f
8898 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
8899
8900 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
8901 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
8902 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
8903 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
8904 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
8905
8906 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
8907 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
8908 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
8909 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
8910 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
8911
8912 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
8913 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
8914 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
8915
8916 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
8917 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
8918 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
8919 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
8920 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
8921 results.
8922
8923 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
8924 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
8925 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
8926 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
8927 \f
8928 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
8929
8930 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
8931 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
8932 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
8933 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
8934
8935 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
8936 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
8937 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
8938 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
8939 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
8940 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
8941 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
8942 region.
8943
8944 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
8945 selective undo.
8946
8947 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
8948 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
8949 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
8950 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
8951 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
8952
8953 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
8954 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
8955 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
8956 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
8957
8958 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
8959 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
8960 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
8961 something that most users not do.
8962
8963 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
8964 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
8965 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
8966 applications.
8967
8968 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
8969 pasting operations.
8970
8971 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
8972 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
8973 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
8974 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
8975 `ps-printer-name'.
8976
8977 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
8978 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
8979 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
8980 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
8981 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
8982 hits a new word.
8983
8984 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
8985 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
8986 to be confused by TeX commands.
8987
8988 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
8989 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
8990 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
8991 of various alternative replacements and actions.
8992
8993 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
8994 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
8995 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
8996 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
8997 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
8998
8999 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
9000 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
9001
9002 ** Changes in input method usage.
9003
9004 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
9005 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
9006 respectively.
9007
9008 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
9009
9010 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
9011 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
9012
9013 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
9014 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
9015
9016 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
9017
9018 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
9019
9020 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
9021 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
9022
9023 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
9024 given in the following case:
9025 o When you are using a complex input method.
9026 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
9027
9028 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
9029 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
9030 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
9031 setting it to t is helpful.
9032
9033 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
9034
9035 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
9036 keys:
9037 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
9038 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
9039 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
9040 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
9041 environment.
9042
9043 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
9044 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
9045 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
9046 get
9047
9048 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
9049
9050 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
9051
9052 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
9053 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
9054
9055 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
9056 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
9057 its owner and group.
9058
9059 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
9060 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
9061
9062 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
9063 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
9064
9065 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
9066 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
9067 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
9068 by the left edge of the rectangle.
9069
9070 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
9071 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
9072 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
9073 for writing keyboard macros.
9074
9075 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
9076 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
9077 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
9078 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
9079 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
9080 info.
9081
9082 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
9083
9084 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
9085 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
9086 contents only.
9087
9088 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
9089 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
9090 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
9091 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
9092
9093 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
9094 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
9095 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
9096
9097 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
9098 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
9099 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
9100 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
9101
9102 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
9103 failure if the command produces no output.
9104
9105 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
9106 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
9107 the mouse.
9108
9109 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
9110 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
9111 function and variable names.
9112
9113 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
9114 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
9115 file-coding-system-alist.
9116
9117 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
9118 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
9119 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
9120 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
9121 according to the current fontset.
9122
9123 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
9124
9125 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
9126 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
9127 nonascii-insert-offset.
9128
9129 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
9130 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
9131 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
9132 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
9133
9134 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
9135 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
9136
9137 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
9138 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
9139
9140 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
9141 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
9142 command keys.
9143
9144 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
9145 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
9146
9147 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
9148 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
9149 all variables that have documentation.
9150
9151 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
9152 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
9153 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
9154 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
9155 it should show; the default is 20.
9156
9157 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
9158 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
9159 of your input.
9160
9161 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
9162 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
9163 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
9164 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
9165 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
9166 Newly added options are included as well.
9167
9168 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
9169 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
9170 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
9171
9172 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
9173 Customize menu.
9174
9175 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
9176 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
9177
9178 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
9179 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
9180 invoked.
9181
9182 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
9183 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
9184 The default is 1.
9185
9186 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
9187 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
9188 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
9189 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
9190 sensibly.
9191
9192 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
9193
9194 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
9195 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
9196 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
9197
9198 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
9199 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
9200 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
9201 every night.
9202
9203 ** Desktop changes
9204
9205 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
9206 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
9207
9208 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
9209 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
9210
9211 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
9212 read and post multi-lingual articles.
9213
9214 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
9215 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
9216 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
9217 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
9218 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
9219 made invisible again.
9220
9221 ** Mail reading and sending changes
9222
9223 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
9224 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
9225 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
9226 toggle.
9227
9228 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
9229 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
9230 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
9231 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
9232 rmail-default-body-file.
9233
9234 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
9235 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
9236 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
9237
9238 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
9239 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
9240 is evaluated to insert the signature.
9241
9242 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
9243 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
9244 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
9245 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
9246 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
9247 especially interested in trying feedmail.
9248
9249 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
9250 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
9251 provided by feedmail are:
9252
9253 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
9254 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
9255 there is also a queue for draft messages
9256
9257 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
9258 be prompted for confirmation
9259
9260 **** does smart filling of address headers
9261
9262 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
9263 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
9264 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
9265
9266 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
9267 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
9268 /usr/lib/sendmail, and elisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
9269 function for something else (10-20 lines of elisp)
9270
9271 ** Dired changes
9272
9273 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
9274 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
9275
9276 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
9277 run Dired on the directory name at point.
9278
9279 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
9280 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
9281 for a specified regexp.
9282
9283 ** VC Changes
9284
9285 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
9286 conveniently.
9287
9288 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
9289 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
9290 Dired.
9291
9292 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
9293 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
9294 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
9295 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
9296
9297 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
9298 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
9299 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
9300 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
9301 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
9302
9303 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
9304 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
9305 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
9306 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
9307 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
9308
9309 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
9310 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
9311 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
9312 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
9313
9314 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
9315 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
9316 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
9317
9318 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
9319 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
9320 session to resolve them.
9321
9322 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
9323 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
9324 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
9325 uses as well).
9326
9327 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
9328 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
9329 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
9330 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
9331 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
9332 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
9333 using ediff.
9334
9335 ** Changes in Font Lock
9336
9337 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
9338 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
9339 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
9340 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
9341 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
9342
9343 ** Frame name display changes
9344
9345 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
9346 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
9347 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
9348 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
9349
9350 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
9351 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
9352 menu.
9353
9354 ** Comint (subshell) changes
9355
9356 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
9357 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
9358 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
9359
9360 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
9361
9362 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
9363 that is, the line after the last line you got.
9364 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
9365
9366 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
9367 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
9368 the following line.
9369
9370 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
9371 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
9372 previously sent input.
9373
9374 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
9375 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
9376 as the search string.
9377
9378 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
9379 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
9380
9381 ** C mode changes
9382
9383 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
9384 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
9385 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
9386 definition.
9387
9388 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
9389 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
9390 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
9391 style is still the default however.
9392
9393 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
9394
9395 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
9396 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
9397 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
9398
9399 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
9400 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
9401
9402 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
9403 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
9404
9405 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
9406 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
9407
9408 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
9409 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
9410
9411 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
9412 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
9413 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
9414 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
9415
9416 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
9417
9418 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
9419 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
9420 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
9421
9422 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
9423 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
9424 expanding dynamically.
9425
9426 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
9427 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
9428
9429 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
9430 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
9431 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
9432 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
9433
9434 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
9435
9436 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
9437
9438 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
9439 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
9440 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
9441 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
9442 against the first word in the title.
9443
9444 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
9445 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
9446 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
9447 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
9448 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
9449 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
9450
9451 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
9452 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
9453 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
9454 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
9455
9456 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
9457
9458 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
9459 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
9460 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
9461 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
9462 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
9463 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
9464
9465 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
9466 Editing group once the package is loaded.
9467
9468 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
9469 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
9470 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
9471
9472 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
9473 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
9474
9475 ** Ispell changes.
9476
9477 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
9478 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
9479 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
9480
9481 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
9482 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
9483 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
9484 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
9485 include:
9486
9487 o URLs are automatically skipped
9488 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
9489
9490 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
9491
9492 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
9493
9494 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
9495 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
9496 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
9497 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
9498
9499 *** New recursive parser.
9500
9501 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
9502 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
9503 recursive parser scans the individual files.
9504
9505 *** Parsing only part of a document.
9506
9507 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
9508 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
9509 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
9510
9511 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
9512
9513 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
9514
9515 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
9516
9517 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
9518
9519 *** Using multiple selection buffers
9520
9521 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
9522 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
9523
9524 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
9525
9526 *** References to external documents.
9527
9528 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
9529 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
9530 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
9531 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
9532 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
9533 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
9534 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
9535
9536 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
9537
9538 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
9539 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
9540
9541 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
9542 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
9543
9544 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
9545
9546 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
9547 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
9548
9549 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
9550
9551 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
9552 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
9553 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
9554 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
9555 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
9556 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
9557 more.
9558
9559 *** Support for the varioref package
9560
9561 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
9562
9563 *** New hooks
9564
9565 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
9566 and citations are created. These hooks are
9567 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
9568 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
9569
9570 *** Citations outside LaTeX
9571
9572 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
9573 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
9574
9575 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
9576
9577 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
9578 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
9579 fontified, use
9580
9581 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
9582
9583 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
9584 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
9585 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
9586 directories that contain the same file name.
9587
9588 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
9589 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
9590 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
9591 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
9592 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
9593 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
9594 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
9595 directory.
9596
9597 ** New modes and packages
9598
9599 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
9600 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
9601 it, but some do not.
9602
9603 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
9604 code.
9605
9606 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
9607 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
9608 around in a buffer.
9609
9610 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
9611
9612 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
9613 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
9614 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
9615 established system of notation similar to Chess.
9616
9617 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
9618 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
9619 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
9620
9621 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
9622 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
9623 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
9624 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
9625 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
9626 the like.
9627
9628 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
9629 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
9630
9631 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
9632 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
9633 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
9634 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
9635
9636 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
9637
9638 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
9639 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
9640 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
9641 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
9642 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
9643 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
9644 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
9645 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
9646 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
9647 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
9648 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
9649
9650 Platform-specific modes:
9651
9652 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
9653 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
9654 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
9655 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
9656 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
9657 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
9658 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
9659 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
9660 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
9661 \f
9662 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
9663
9664 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
9665 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
9666 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
9667 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
9668
9669 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
9670 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
9671 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
9672
9673 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
9674 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
9675 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
9676 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
9677
9678 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
9679 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
9680 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
9681 environment.
9682
9683 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
9684 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
9685 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
9686 current input method for reading this one event.
9687
9688 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
9689 now control whether to output certain characters as
9690 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
9691 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
9692 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
9693 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
9694 \f
9695 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
9696
9697 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
9698 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
9699
9700 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
9701 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
9702 always increases point by 1.
9703
9704 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
9705 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
9706
9707 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
9708
9709 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
9710 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
9711 default value changed. For example,
9712
9713 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
9714 :type 'integer
9715 :group 'foo
9716 :version "20.3")
9717
9718 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
9719 :version "20.3")
9720
9721 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
9722 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
9723 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
9724 `:version' in the top level group.
9725
9726 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
9727
9728 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
9729 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
9730
9731 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
9732 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
9733 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
9734 to themselves.
9735
9736 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
9737 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
9738 values whatever.
9739
9740 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
9741 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
9742 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
9743
9744 ** Frame-local variables.
9745
9746 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
9747 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
9748 local bindings for that variable.
9749
9750 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
9751 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
9752 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
9753 parameter name.
9754
9755 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
9756 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
9757 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
9758 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
9759
9760 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
9761 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
9762 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
9763 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
9764
9765 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
9766 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
9767 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
9768 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
9769 See the documentation in sregex.el.
9770
9771 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
9772 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
9773 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
9774 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
9775
9776 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
9777 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
9778
9779 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
9780 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
9781 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
9782
9783 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
9784 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
9785 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
9786 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
9787
9788 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
9789 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
9790 empty input.
9791
9792 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
9793 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
9794 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
9795 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
9796 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
9797
9798 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
9799 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
9800 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
9801 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
9802
9803 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
9804 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
9805 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
9806 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
9807 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
9808
9809 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
9810 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
9811 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
9812 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
9813
9814 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
9815 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
9816 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
9817
9818 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
9819 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
9820 was directed to display this buffer.
9821
9822 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
9823 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
9824 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
9825 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
9826 set-window-configuration.
9827
9828 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
9829 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
9830 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
9831 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
9832
9833 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
9834 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
9835 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
9836
9837 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
9838 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
9839 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
9840
9841 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
9842 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
9843
9844 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
9845 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
9846
9847 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
9848 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
9849 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
9850
9851 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
9852 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
9853 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
9854 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
9855
9856 ** Menu changes
9857
9858 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
9859 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
9860 better supported.
9861
9862 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
9863 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
9864 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
9865 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
9866 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
9867
9868 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
9869
9870 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
9871 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
9872 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
9873 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
9874
9875 The format is:
9876 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
9877 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
9878 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
9879 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
9880 The supported properties include
9881
9882 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
9883 item is enabled.
9884 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
9885 item should appear in the menu.
9886 :filter FILTER-FN
9887 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
9888 which will be REAL-BINDING.
9889 It should return a binding to use instead.
9890 :keys DESCRIPTION
9891 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
9892 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
9893 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
9894 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
9895 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
9896 keyboard binding.
9897 :key-sequence nil
9898 This means that the command normally has no
9899 keyboard equivalent.
9900 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
9901 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
9902 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
9903 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
9904 value says whether this button is currently selected.
9905
9906 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
9907 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
9908
9909 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
9910
9911 ** New event types
9912
9913 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
9914 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
9915 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
9916 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
9917
9918 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
9919
9920 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
9921 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
9922 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
9923 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
9924 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
9925 forward, away from the user.
9926
9927 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
9928
9929 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
9930 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
9931 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
9932 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
9933 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
9934
9935 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
9936
9937 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
9938 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
9939 that were dragged and dropped.
9940
9941 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
9942
9943 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
9944
9945 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
9946 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
9947 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
9948
9949 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
9950 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
9951 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
9952
9953 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
9954 in Emacs 19 and before.
9955
9956 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
9957 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
9958
9959 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
9960 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
9961 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
9962 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
9963
9964 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
9965 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
9966 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
9967 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
9968 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
9969
9970 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
9971 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
9972 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
9973 consistent with the new representation.
9974
9975 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
9976 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
9977 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
9978 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
9979
9980 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
9981 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
9982 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
9983
9984 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
9985 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
9986 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
9987
9988 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
9989 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
9990 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
9991
9992 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
9993 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
9994
9995 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
9996 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
9997
9998 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
9999 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
10000 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
10001 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
10002
10003 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
10004 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
10005
10006 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
10007 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
10008 buffer or string being searched.
10009
10010 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
10011 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
10012 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
10013 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
10014 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
10015 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
10016 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
10017
10018 *** Structure of coding system changed.
10019
10020 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
10021 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
10022 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
10023 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
10024 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
10025 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
10026 define-coding-system-alias.
10027
10028 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
10029 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
10030 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
10031 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
10032 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
10033 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
10034 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
10035 `iso-8859-1'.
10036
10037 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
10038 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
10039 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
10040 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
10041
10042 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
10043 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
10044 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
10045 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
10046
10047 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
10048 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
10049 This function requires a user interaction.
10050
10051 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
10052 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
10053 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
10054 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
10055 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
10056 select-safe-coding-system.
10057
10058 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
10059 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
10060 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
10061 was done.
10062
10063 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
10064 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
10065 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
10066
10067 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
10068 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
10069 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
10070 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
10071
10072 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
10073 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
10074 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
10075 converted.
10076
10077 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
10078 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
10079
10080 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
10081 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
10082 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
10083 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
10084 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
10085 range of characters.
10086
10087 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
10088 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
10089
10090 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
10091 in the current buffer at position POS.
10092
10093 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
10094 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
10095 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
10096 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
10097 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
10098 binding input-method-function to nil.
10099
10100 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
10101 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
10102 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
10103 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
10104 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
10105
10106 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
10107 subsequent events of a key sequence.
10108
10109 *** You can customize any language environment by using
10110 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
10111
10112 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
10113 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
10114 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
10115 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
10116 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
10117 \f
10118 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
10119
10120 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
10121 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
10122 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
10123 tree structure.
10124
10125 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
10126 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
10127
10128 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
10129 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
10130 in your .emacs file.)
10131
10132 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
10133 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
10134
10135 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
10136 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
10137
10138 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
10139 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
10140 kills the region.
10141
10142 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
10143 delete the character before point, as usual.
10144
10145 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
10146 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
10147 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
10148
10149 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
10150 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
10151 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
10152 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
10153 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
10154 past.)
10155
10156 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
10157 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
10158 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
10159 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
10160 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
10161
10162 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
10163 and is an alias for it.
10164
10165 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
10166 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
10167
10168 ** Scrolling changes
10169
10170 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
10171 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
10172
10173 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
10174 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
10175 where it started.
10176
10177 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
10178 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
10179 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
10180 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
10181
10182 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
10183 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
10184 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
10185 recenters the window.
10186
10187 ** International character set support (MULE)
10188
10189 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
10190 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
10191 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
10192 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
10193 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
10194 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
10195
10196 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
10197 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
10198 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
10199 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
10200 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
10201
10202 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
10203 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
10204 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
10205 language, to make it possible to type them.
10206
10207 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
10208 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
10209
10210 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
10211 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
10212
10213 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
10214
10215 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
10216
10217 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
10218 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
10219 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
10220 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
10221 characters for their work until they want to change.
10222
10223 *** Input methods
10224
10225 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
10226 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
10227 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
10228 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
10229 support several input methods.
10230
10231 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
10232 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
10233 work.
10234
10235 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
10236 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
10237 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
10238 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
10239 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
10240 letter.
10241
10242 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
10243 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
10244 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
10245 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
10246 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
10247
10248 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
10249 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
10250 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
10251 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
10252
10253 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
10254 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
10255 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
10256 the first guess is wrong.
10257
10258 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
10259 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
10260
10261 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
10262 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
10263 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
10264 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
10265
10266 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
10267 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
10268 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
10269 translate automatically to and from either one.
10270
10271 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
10272
10273 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
10274 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
10275 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
10276 what you want.
10277
10278 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
10279 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
10280 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
10281 multibyte characters in that buffer.
10282
10283 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
10284 character conversion as well.
10285
10286 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
10287
10288 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
10289 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
10290 requires using many fonts.
10291
10292 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
10293 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
10294
10295 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
10296 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
10297 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
10298 you would use a font.
10299
10300 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
10301 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
10302 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
10303
10304 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
10305 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
10306 characters).
10307
10308 *** Defining fontsets.
10309
10310 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
10311 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
10312 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
10313
10314 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
10315 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
10316 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
10317 standard fontset are created automatically.
10318
10319 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
10320 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
10321 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
10322 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
10323 name is `fontset-startup'.
10324
10325 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
10326 The resource value should have this form:
10327 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
10328 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
10329 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
10330 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
10331 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
10332 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
10333 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
10334 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
10335 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
10336
10337 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
10338 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
10339 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
10340
10341 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
10342 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
10343 following resource,
10344 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
10345 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
10346 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
10347 Here is the substitution rule:
10348 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
10349 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
10350 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
10351 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
10352 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
10353
10354 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
10355 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
10356 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
10357
10358 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
10359 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
10360 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
10361 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
10362 fontsets.
10363
10364 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
10365 defaults for a particular choice of language.
10366
10367 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
10368 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
10369 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
10370 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
10371 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
10372 system for new files that you create.
10373
10374 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
10375 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
10376 whole Emacs session.
10377
10378 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
10379 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
10380 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
10381
10382 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
10383 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
10384 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
10385 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
10386 coding systems that Emacs supports.
10387
10388 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
10389 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
10390 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
10391 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
10392 is used for *the immediately following command*.
10393
10394 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
10395 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
10396
10397 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
10398 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
10399
10400 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
10401 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
10402
10403 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
10404 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
10405 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
10406 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
10407 of the file.
10408
10409 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
10410 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
10411 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
10412 translated into that character code.
10413
10414 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
10415 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
10416
10417 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
10418
10419 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
10420 the coding system for keyboard input.
10421
10422 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
10423 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
10424 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
10425
10426 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
10427
10428 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
10429 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
10430 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
10431 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
10432 designed to work with terminals.
10433
10434 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
10435 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
10436 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
10437 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
10438 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
10439 in the corresponding buffer.
10440
10441 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
10442
10443 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
10444 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
10445 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
10446
10447 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
10448 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
10449 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
10450 want to use.
10451
10452 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
10453 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
10454
10455 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
10456 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
10457 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
10458 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
10459
10460 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
10461 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
10462 related information.
10463
10464 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
10465 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
10466 scripts.
10467
10468 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
10469 information about the support for a particular language.
10470 You specify the language as an argument.
10471
10472 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
10473 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
10474 first dash.
10475
10476 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
10477 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
10478 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
10479 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
10480
10481 A alternativnyj (Russian)
10482 B big5 (Chinese)
10483 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
10484 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
10485 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
10486 E euc-japan (Japanese)
10487 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
10488 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
10489 K euc-korea (Korean)
10490 R koi8 (Russian)
10491 Q tibetan
10492 S shift_jis (Japanese)
10493 T lao
10494 T tis620 (Thai)
10495 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
10496 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
10497 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
10498 v viqr (Vietnamese)
10499 z hz (Chinese)
10500
10501 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
10502 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
10503 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
10504 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
10505
10506 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
10507 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
10508
10509 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
10510 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
10511 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
10512 Rmail files themselves.
10513
10514 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
10515 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
10516
10517 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
10518 for sending mail:
10519
10520 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
10521 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
10522 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
10523 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
10524 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
10525
10526 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
10527 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
10528 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
10529 translations.
10530
10531 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
10532 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
10533 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
10534 without any conversion.
10535
10536 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
10537 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
10538 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
10539 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
10540
10541 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
10542 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
10543
10544 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
10545 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
10546
10547 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
10548 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
10549
10550 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
10551 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
10552 in the buffer before point.
10553
10554 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
10555 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
10556 you are using.
10557
10558 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
10559 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
10560
10561 ** File locking works with NFS now.
10562
10563 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
10564 in the same directory as FILENAME.
10565
10566 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
10567 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
10568 can become a bottleneck.
10569
10570 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
10571 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
10572 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
10573 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
10574 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
10575 so useful that the change is worth while.
10576
10577 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
10578 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
10579 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
10580 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
10581
10582 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
10583 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
10584 show-paren-mode.
10585
10586 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
10587 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
10588 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
10589
10590 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
10591 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
10592 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
10593
10594 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
10595 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
10596 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
10597
10598 ** Changes in View mode.
10599
10600 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
10601 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
10602
10603 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
10604 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
10605
10606 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
10607 previous state.
10608
10609 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
10610 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
10611
10612 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
10613 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
10614 not just the selected window.
10615
10616 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
10617 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
10618 turns View mode on or off.
10619
10620 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
10621 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
10622 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
10623
10624 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
10625 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
10626
10627 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
10628 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
10629 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
10630 which version to compare with.
10631
10632 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
10633 blocks if a match is inside the block.
10634
10635 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
10636 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
10637 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
10638 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
10639
10640 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
10641 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
10642 blocks, all of them or none.
10643
10644 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
10645 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
10646 confirmation first.
10647
10648 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
10649 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
10650 However, the mode will not be changed if
10651 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
10652 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
10653 not suitable for ordinary files, or
10654 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
10655
10656 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
10657
10658 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
10659 these commands do not change the major mode.
10660
10661 ** M-x occur changes.
10662
10663 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
10664 it performs a case-sensitive search.
10665
10666 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
10667 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
10668 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
10669
10670 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
10671 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
10672 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
10673 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
10674 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
10675
10676 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
10677 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
10678 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
10679 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
10680
10681 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
10682 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
10683 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
10684
10685 ** Outline mode changes.
10686
10687 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
10688
10689 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
10690
10691 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
10692 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
10693 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
10694 was already active.
10695
10696 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
10697 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
10698 get confused by it.
10699
10700 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
10701 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
10702
10703 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
10704
10705 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
10706 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
10707 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
10708 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
10709
10710 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
10711 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
10712 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
10713
10714 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
10715 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
10716 values.
10717
10718 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
10719 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
10720 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
10721 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
10722
10723 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
10724 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
10725 can be. The default value is 30.
10726
10727 ** Changes in Mail mode.
10728
10729 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
10730 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
10731 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
10732 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
10733 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
10734 behavior.
10735
10736 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
10737 compose-mail-other-frame.
10738
10739 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
10740 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
10741 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
10742 buffer that shows the original message.
10743
10744 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
10745 with separator lines around the contents.
10746
10747 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
10748 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
10749 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
10750 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
10751
10752 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
10753
10754 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
10755 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
10756 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
10757 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
10758
10759 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
10760 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
10761 /etc/passwd.
10762
10763 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
10764 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
10765 /etc/passwd.
10766
10767 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
10768 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
10769 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
10770 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
10771
10772 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
10773 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
10774 be taken to be magic.
10775
10776 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
10777 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
10778 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
10779
10780 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
10781 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
10782
10783 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
10784 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
10785
10786 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
10787
10788 new key dired.el binding old key
10789 ------- ---------------- -------
10790 * c dired-change-marks c
10791 * m dired-mark m
10792 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
10793 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
10794 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
10795 * u dired-unmark u
10796 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
10797 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
10798 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
10799 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
10800 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
10801 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
10802
10803 ** Rmail changes.
10804
10805 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
10806 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
10807 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
10808 each time you run it.
10809
10810 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
10811 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
10812
10813 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
10814 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
10815 means to move in the opposite direction.
10816
10817 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
10818 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
10819
10820 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
10821 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
10822 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
10823 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
10824 for output.
10825
10826 ** Gnus changes.
10827
10828 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
10829
10830 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
10831 Gnus.
10832
10833 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
10834 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
10835
10836 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
10837 article mode line.
10838
10839 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
10840
10841 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
10842
10843 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
10844
10845 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
10846 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
10847 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
10848
10849 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
10850
10851 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
10852
10853 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
10854 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
10855
10856 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
10857 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
10858 used to pick articles.
10859
10860 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
10861 another have been added.
10862
10863 `M-x gnus-change-server'
10864
10865 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
10866 generating lines in buffers.
10867
10868 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
10869 `C-M-_'.
10870
10871 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
10872
10873 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
10874
10875 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
10876
10877 *** Scores can be decayed.
10878
10879 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
10880
10881 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
10882 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
10883
10884 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
10885 the native server.
10886
10887 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
10888
10889 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
10890 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
10891
10892 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
10893
10894 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
10895 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
10896
10897 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
10898 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
10899
10900 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
10901 a group.
10902
10903 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
10904 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
10905
10906 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
10907
10908 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
10909
10910 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
10911
10912 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
10913
10914 Use the `Y c' command.
10915
10916 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
10917
10918 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
10919
10920 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
10921
10922 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
10923 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
10924
10925 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
10926
10927 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
10928
10929 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
10930 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
10931
10932 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
10933
10934 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
10935 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
10936 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
10937 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
10938 this issue.)
10939
10940 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
10941 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
10942 particular news group. This can be done by:
10943
10944 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
10945
10946 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
10947 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
10948 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
10949 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
10950 for reading and posting).
10951
10952 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
10953 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
10954 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
10955 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
10956 there.
10957
10958 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
10959 default. Here are some of these default settings:
10960
10961 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
10962 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
10963 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
10964 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
10965 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
10966
10967 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
10968 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
10969
10970 ** CC mode changes.
10971
10972 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
10973 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
10974 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
10975 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
10976 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
10977 loaded.
10978
10979 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
10980 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
10981 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
10982 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
10983 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
10984 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
10985
10986 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
10987 of the current buffer.
10988
10989 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
10990 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
10991 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
10992
10993 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
10994 style that the Python developers like.
10995
10996 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
10997 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
10998 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
10999
11000 ** VC Changes [new]
11001
11002 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
11003 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
11004 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
11005
11006 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
11007 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
11008 developers.
11009
11010 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
11011 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
11012
11013 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
11014 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
11015 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
11016 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
11017
11018 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
11019 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
11020
11021 ** Calendar changes.
11022
11023 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
11024 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
11025 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
11026 following/previous years.
11027
11028 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
11029 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
11030 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
11031 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
11032 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
11033 supposed attribute of God.
11034
11035 ** ps-print changes
11036
11037 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
11038 layout.
11039
11040 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
11041
11042 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
11043 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
11044 printer system has this behavior, set variable
11045 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
11046
11047 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
11048 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
11049 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
11050
11051 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
11052 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
11053
11054 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
11055 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
11056 printing for your printer.
11057
11058 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
11059 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
11060
11061 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
11062 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
11063
11064 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
11065 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
11066 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
11067 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
11068 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
11069 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
11070 The default value is nil.
11071
11072 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
11073 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
11074
11075 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
11076 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
11077 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
11078 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
11079 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
11080 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
11081 color). The default is 0 ("black").
11082
11083 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
11084 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
11085
11086 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
11087 The default is 0 ("black").
11088
11089 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
11090 The default is 0 ("black").
11091
11092 border-width Specify the border width.
11093 The default is 0.4.
11094
11095 Any other property is ignored.
11096
11097 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
11098 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
11099 documentation).
11100
11101 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
11102 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
11103 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
11104 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
11105 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
11106 controlling headers.
11107
11108 *** Color management (subgroup)
11109
11110 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
11111 color.
11112
11113 *** Face Management (subgroup)
11114
11115 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
11116 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
11117 background should be used. Valid values are:
11118
11119 t always use face background color.
11120 nil never use face background color.
11121 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
11122
11123 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
11124
11125 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
11126 sheet of paper.
11127
11128 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
11129 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
11130
11131 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
11132 each page.
11133
11134 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
11135 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
11136 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
11137
11138 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
11139 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
11140 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
11141
11142 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
11143 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
11144 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
11145
11146 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
11147 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
11148 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
11149
11150 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
11151 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
11152 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
11153
11154 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
11155
11156 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
11157
11158 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
11159 RGB color.
11160
11161 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
11162 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
11163 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
11164
11165 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
11166 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11167 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11168 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11169 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11170 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
11171 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
11172 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
11173 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11174 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11175 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11176 10 + 10 +
11177 11 + 11 +
11178 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11179 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11180 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
11181 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
11182 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
11183 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11184 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11185 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11186 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
11187 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
11188 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
11189 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
11190 22 + 22 +
11191 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11192
11193 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
11194
11195
11196 *** Printer management (subgroup)
11197
11198 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
11199 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
11200 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
11201 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
11202 to "-P".
11203
11204 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
11205 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
11206 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
11207
11208 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
11209 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
11210 do so.
11211
11212 *** Page settings (subgroup)
11213
11214 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
11215 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
11216 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
11217 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
11218 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
11219 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
11220 `setpagedevice'.
11221
11222 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
11223 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
11224 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
11225
11226 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
11227 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
11228 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
11229 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
11230 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
11231 its TO, are ignored.
11232
11233 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
11234 pages. Valid values are:
11235
11236 nil print all pages.
11237
11238 `even-page' print only even pages.
11239
11240 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
11241
11242 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
11243 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
11244 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
11245 print only the even sheet of paper.
11246
11247 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
11248 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
11249 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
11250 only the odd sheet of paper.
11251
11252 Any other value is treated as nil.
11253
11254 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
11255 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
11256 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
11257
11258 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
11259
11260 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
11261 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
11262
11263 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
11264 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
11265 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
11266 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
11267 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
11268 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
11269 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
11270
11271 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
11272 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
11273 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
11274 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
11275 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
11276 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
11277 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
11278
11279 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
11280
11281 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
11282 messages should be sent.
11283
11284 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
11285 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
11286 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
11287
11288 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
11289
11290 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
11291 points for line numbers.
11292
11293 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
11294 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
11295
11296 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
11297 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
11298 to 2, the printing will look like:
11299
11300 1 one line
11301 one line
11302 3 one line
11303 one line
11304 5 one line
11305 one line
11306 ...
11307
11308 Valid values are:
11309
11310 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
11311 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
11312 is used.
11313
11314 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
11315 zebra stripe is to be printed.
11316
11317 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
11318
11319 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
11320 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
11321 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
11322 3, the output will look like:
11323
11324 one line
11325 one line
11326 3 one line
11327 one line
11328 one line
11329 6 one line
11330 one line
11331 one line
11332 9 one line
11333 one line
11334 ...
11335
11336 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
11337 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
11338
11339 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
11340 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
11341 `ps-font-size').
11342
11343 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
11344 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
11345 `ps-font-size').
11346
11347 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
11348
11349 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
11350 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
11351
11352 ** hideshow changes.
11353
11354 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
11355 C++, ; for lisp).
11356
11357 *** Support for java-mode added.
11358
11359 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
11360 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
11361
11362 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
11363 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
11364 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
11365
11366 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
11367 robust and a lot faster.
11368
11369 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
11370
11371 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
11372 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
11373 documentation for more details.
11374
11375 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
11376
11377 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
11378 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
11379 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
11380 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
11381 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
11382
11383 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
11384 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
11385 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
11386 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
11387
11388 ** Font Lock mode
11389
11390 *** Custom support
11391
11392 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
11393 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
11394 faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
11395 group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
11396 your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
11397 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
11398
11399 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
11400
11401 *** Maximum decoration
11402
11403 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
11404 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
11405 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
11406 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
11407 to get the old behavior.
11408
11409 *** New support
11410
11411 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
11412
11413 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
11414 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
11415
11416 *** Configurable support
11417
11418 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
11419 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
11420 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
11421 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
11422 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
11423 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
11424 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
11425
11426 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
11427 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
11428 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
11429
11430 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
11431
11432 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
11433 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
11434 for any mode.
11435
11436 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
11437
11438 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
11439
11440 in your ~/.emacs.
11441
11442 *** New faces
11443
11444 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
11445 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
11446 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
11447 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
11448
11449 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
11450
11451 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
11452 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
11453 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
11454
11455 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
11456
11457 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
11458 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
11459 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
11460 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
11461 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
11462 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
11463 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
11464
11465 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
11466 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
11467 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
11468 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
11469 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
11470 the command M-g M-g (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
11471
11472 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
11473
11474 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
11475 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
11476 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
11477 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
11478
11479 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
11480 settings.
11481
11482 ** Ada mode changes.
11483
11484 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
11485 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
11486 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
11487 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
11488 stubs.
11489
11490 *** There are two new commands:
11491 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
11492 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
11493
11494 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
11495 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
11496 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
11497
11498 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
11499 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
11500 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
11501
11502 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
11503 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
11504 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
11505 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
11506
11507 ** Scheme mode changes.
11508
11509 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
11510 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
11511 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
11512 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
11513 have any effect.
11514
11515 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
11516 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
11517 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
11518 variables as buffer-local variables.
11519
11520 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
11521 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
11522
11523 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
11524
11525 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
11526 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
11527 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
11528 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
11529
11530 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
11531 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
11532 buffer in Emacs.
11533
11534 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
11535 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
11536 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
11537 option takes precedence.
11538
11539 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
11540 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
11541 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
11542
11543 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
11544 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
11545 the current defun.
11546
11547 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
11548 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
11549
11550 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
11551 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
11552 necessary).
11553
11554 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
11555 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
11556 these register values no longer become completely useless.
11557 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
11558 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
11559 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
11560
11561 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
11562 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
11563 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
11564 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
11565
11566 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
11567 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
11568 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
11569 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
11570 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
11571
11572 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
11573 since it applies only to the current frame.
11574
11575 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
11576 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
11577 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
11578
11579 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
11580 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
11581 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
11582 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
11583 instead of just the file you are editing.
11584
11585 ** RefTeX mode
11586
11587 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
11588 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
11589 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
11590 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
11591 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
11592
11593 C-c ( reftex-label
11594 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
11595 knows which kind of label is needed.
11596
11597 C-c ) reftex-reference
11598 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
11599 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
11600
11601 C-c [ reftex-citation
11602 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
11603 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
11604
11605 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
11606 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
11607
11608 C-c = reftex-toc
11609 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
11610 can quickly jump to every section.
11611
11612 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
11613 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
11614 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
11615 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
11616 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
11617
11618 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
11619
11620 *** Info documentation is now available.
11621
11622 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
11623 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
11624
11625 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
11626 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
11627
11628 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
11629 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
11630
11631 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
11632 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
11633 appropriate functions.
11634
11635 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
11636 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
11637
11638 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
11639 been cleaned.
11640
11641 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
11642 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
11643
11644 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
11645 shall be delimited.
11646
11647 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
11648 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
11649 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
11650
11651 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
11652 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
11653 prefixed with `ALT'.
11654
11655 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
11656 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
11657 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
11658 documentation).
11659
11660 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
11661 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
11662 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
11663
11664 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
11665 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
11666
11667 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
11668 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
11669 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
11670
11671 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
11672
11673 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
11674
11675 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
11676 from alien sources.
11677
11678 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
11679 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
11680 crossref entries.
11681
11682 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
11683 region.
11684
11685 *** Added support for imenu.
11686
11687 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
11688 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
11689 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
11690 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
11691
11692 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
11693 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
11694
11695 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
11696
11697 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
11698
11699 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
11700 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
11701 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
11702 as an argument.
11703
11704 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
11705 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
11706
11707 ** browse-url changes
11708
11709 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
11710 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
11711 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
11712 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
11713 customization variables.
11714
11715 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
11716
11717 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
11718 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
11719 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
11720
11721 ** Changes in Ediff
11722
11723 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
11724 pops up the Info file for this command.
11725
11726 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
11727 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
11728 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
11729 directories).
11730
11731 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
11732 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
11733 files in the same directory.
11734
11735 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
11736 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
11737 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
11738
11739 ** Changes in Viper
11740
11741 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
11742 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
11743 instead of vip-.
11744 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
11745 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
11746 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
11747 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
11748 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
11749 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
11750 color when Viper is in insert state.
11751 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
11752 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
11753 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
11754
11755 ** Etags changes.
11756
11757 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
11758 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
11759 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
11760 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
11761 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
11762
11763 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
11764
11765 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
11766 constructs are tagged. Files are recognised by the extension .java.
11767
11768 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
11769 recognised by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
11770 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
11771
11772 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
11773 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
11774 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
11775 methods and protocols.
11776
11777 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognised by the extension
11778 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
11779 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
11780 paragraph name.
11781
11782 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
11783 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
11784 at least M times and as many as N times.
11785
11786 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
11787 in files has changed slightly.
11788
11789 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
11790 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
11791 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
11792 with old time-stamp-format values.
11793
11794 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
11795 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
11796 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
11797 reasons.
11798
11799 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
11800 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
11801 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
11802 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
11803 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
11804 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
11805
11806 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
11807 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
11808 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
11809
11810 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
11811 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
11812 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
11813 recommended now will continue to work then.
11814
11815 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
11816 details.
11817
11818 ** There are some additional major modes:
11819
11820 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
11821 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
11822 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
11823
11824 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
11825 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
11826 into Emacs.
11827
11828 ** New Lisp packages include:
11829
11830 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
11831
11832 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
11833 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
11834
11835 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
11836
11837 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
11838 in shell buffers.
11839
11840 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
11841 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
11842 and `elint-defun'.
11843
11844 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
11845 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
11846 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
11847 strings or comments.
11848
11849 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
11850 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
11851 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
11852 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
11853 at these points.
11854
11855 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
11856 can visit them by short forms of their names.
11857
11858 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
11859 Emacs Lisp function at point.
11860
11861 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
11862
11863 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
11864 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
11865
11866 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
11867
11868 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
11869
11870 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
11871
11872 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
11873 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
11874
11875 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
11876 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
11877 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
11878 original place after inserting the copy.
11879
11880 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
11881 on the buffer.
11882
11883 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
11884 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
11885 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
11886
11887 Enable mouse-drag with:
11888 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
11889 -or-
11890 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
11891
11892 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
11893 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
11894
11895 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
11896 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
11897
11898 *** ogonek
11899
11900 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
11901 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
11902 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
11903 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
11904 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
11905 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
11906 instance) and vice versa.
11907
11908 To use this package load it using
11909 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
11910 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
11911 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
11912 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
11913 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
11914 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
11915
11916 *** Interface to ph.
11917
11918 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
11919
11920 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
11921 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
11922 these servers.
11923
11924 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
11925
11926 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
11927 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
11928 while the real cursor does not move.
11929
11930 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
11931 for visiting your favorite web sites.
11932
11933 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
11934 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
11935
11936 ** movemail change
11937
11938 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
11939 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
11940 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
11941 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
11942
11943 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
11944 \f
11945 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
11946
11947 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
11948
11949 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
11950 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
11951 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
11952 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
11953 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
11954
11955 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
11956 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
11957 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
11958 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
11959 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
11960 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
11961 \f
11962 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
11963
11964 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
11965 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
11966 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
11967 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
11968
11969 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
11970 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
11971
11972 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
11973 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
11974 "win".
11975
11976 ** Basic Lisp changes
11977
11978 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
11979 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
11980
11981 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
11982 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
11983 or by the user.
11984
11985 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
11986
11987 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
11988
11989 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
11990 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
11991
11992 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
11993 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
11994 its argument.
11995
11996 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
11997
11998 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
11999
12000 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
12001
12002 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
12003 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
12004 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
12005 `format' function.
12006
12007 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
12008 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
12009 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
12010
12011 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
12012 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
12013 adding one of these suffixes.
12014
12015 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
12016 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
12017 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
12018
12019 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
12020 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
12021
12022 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
12023
12024 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
12025 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
12026
12027 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
12028 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
12029
12030 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
12031
12032 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
12033 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
12034
12035 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
12036 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
12037 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
12038 works using `save-current-buffer'.
12039
12040 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
12041 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
12042 of the last form.
12043
12044 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
12045 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
12046 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
12047 as the last form.
12048
12049 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
12050 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
12051 matches.
12052
12053 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
12054
12055 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
12056 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
12057 Then it returns that string.
12058
12059 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
12060
12061 (with-output-to-string
12062 (princ "The buffer is ")
12063 (princ (buffer-name)))
12064
12065 returns "The buffer is foo".
12066
12067 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
12068 is non-nil.
12069
12070 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
12071 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
12072 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
12073
12074 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
12075 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
12076
12077 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
12078 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
12079 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
12080 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
12081 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
12082 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
12083
12084 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
12085 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
12086 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
12087 characters".
12088
12089 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
12090 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
12091 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
12092 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
12093 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
12094
12095 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
12096 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
12097 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
12098 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
12099
12100 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
12101 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
12102
12103 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
12104
12105 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
12106 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
12107 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
12108 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
12109 guaranteed.
12110
12111 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
12112 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
12113 character).
12114
12115 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
12116
12117 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
12118 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
12119 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
12120 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
12121 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
12122
12123 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
12124
12125 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
12126 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
12127 more than the number of characters.
12128
12129 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
12130 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
12131 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
12132 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
12133 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
12134 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
12135
12136 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
12137 and returns a string containing those characters.
12138
12139 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
12140 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
12141 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
12142 character, sref signals an error.
12143
12144 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
12145 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
12146 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
12147
12148 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
12149 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
12150 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
12151
12152 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
12153 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
12154 to a vector of the characters in it.
12155
12156 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
12157 of a string. You call it as follows:
12158
12159 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
12160
12161 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
12162 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
12163 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
12164 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
12165 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
12166
12167 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
12168 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
12169
12170 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
12171 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
12172
12173 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
12174 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
12175 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
12176 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
12177
12178 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
12179
12180 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
12181
12182 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
12183 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
12184 are not included in the resulting value.
12185
12186 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
12187 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
12188 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
12189 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
12190
12191 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
12192 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
12193 character extends across that column), then the padding character
12194 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
12195 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
12196 column START-COLUMN.
12197
12198 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
12199 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
12200 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
12201 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
12202 changed text, before the change.
12203
12204 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
12205 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
12206 one character set for each script, not for each language.
12207
12208 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
12209
12210 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
12211
12212 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
12213 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
12214
12215 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
12216 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
12217 which identify the character within that character set.
12218
12219 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
12220 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
12221 opposite of split-char.
12222
12223 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
12224 of all the characters between BEG and END.
12225
12226 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
12227 of all the characters in a string.
12228
12229 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
12230 and specifying coding systems.
12231
12232 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
12233 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
12234 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
12235 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
12236 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
12237 as what to do about code conversion.)
12238
12239 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
12240 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
12241
12242 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
12243 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
12244 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
12245
12246 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
12247 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
12248 to match against a file name.
12249
12250 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
12251 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
12252 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
12253 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
12254 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
12255 specifies the coding system for encoding.
12256
12257 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
12258 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
12259
12260 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
12261 the coding system to use for network sockets.
12262
12263 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
12264 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
12265 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
12266 service names.
12267
12268 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
12269 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
12270 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
12271 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
12272 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
12273 specifies the coding system for encoding.
12274
12275 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
12276 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
12277
12278 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
12279 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
12280 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
12281 start the subprocess.
12282
12283 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
12284 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
12285 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
12286 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
12287 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
12288
12289 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
12290 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
12291 subprocess.
12292
12293 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
12294 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
12295 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
12296 connection permanently or until overridden.
12297
12298 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
12299 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
12300 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
12301 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
12302 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
12303 system for one operation at a time.
12304
12305 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
12306 files, subprocesses or network connections.
12307
12308 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
12309 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
12310 The value is a cons cell,
12311 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
12312 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
12313 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
12314 input to the subprocess.
12315
12316 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
12317 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
12318
12319 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
12320 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
12321 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
12322
12323 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
12324 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
12325 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
12326 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
12327 customization.
12328
12329 Thus, instead of writing
12330
12331 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
12332 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
12333
12334 you would now write this:
12335
12336 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
12337 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
12338 :type 'boolean
12339 :group foo)
12340
12341 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
12342 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
12343 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
12344 for a description of them.
12345
12346 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
12347 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
12348
12349 (defgroup ispell nil
12350 "Spell checking using Ispell."
12351 :group 'processes)
12352
12353 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
12354 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
12355 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
12356 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
12357 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
12358
12359 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
12360 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
12361 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
12362 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
12363 first-level subgroups.
12364
12365 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
12366
12367 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
12368 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
12369
12370 ** easy-mmode
12371
12372 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
12373 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
12374 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
12375 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
12376 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
12377 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
12378
12379 ** Text property changes
12380
12381 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
12382 text property.
12383
12384 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
12385 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
12386 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
12387 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
12388 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
12389
12390 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
12391 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
12392 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
12393 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
12394
12395 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
12396 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
12397 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
12398
12399 ** Changes in invisibility features
12400
12401 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
12402 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
12403 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
12404 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
12405 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
12406 make the overlay visible.
12407
12408 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
12409 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
12410 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
12411 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
12412 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
12413 t when it should hide it.
12414
12415 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
12416
12417 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
12418 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
12419 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
12420 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
12421 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
12422 Here is an example of how to do this:
12423
12424 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
12425 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
12426 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
12427 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
12428
12429 ...
12430 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
12431
12432 ...
12433 ;; When done with the overlays:
12434 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
12435 ;; Or respectively:
12436 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
12437
12438 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
12439
12440 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
12441 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
12442 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
12443 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
12444
12445 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
12446 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
12447 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
12448
12449 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
12450 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
12451
12452 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
12453 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
12454
12455 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
12456 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
12457 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
12458
12459 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
12460 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
12461 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
12462 determine the syntax type of the character.
12463
12464 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
12465 of the current buffer.
12466
12467 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
12468 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
12469 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
12470
12471 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
12472 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
12473 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
12474 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
12475 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
12476
12477 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
12478 text property.
12479
12480 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
12481 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
12482 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
12483
12484 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
12485 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
12486 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
12487 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
12488 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
12489
12490 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
12491 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
12492 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
12493
12494 ** Changes in face features
12495
12496 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
12497 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
12498
12499 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
12500 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
12501
12502 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
12503 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
12504
12505 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
12506 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
12507
12508 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
12509 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
12510 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
12511 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
12512 overlay property).
12513
12514 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
12515 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
12516
12517 ** Changes in file-handling functions
12518
12519 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
12520 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
12521 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
12522 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
12523
12524 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
12525 begins with ~.
12526
12527 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
12528 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
12529
12530 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
12531 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
12532
12533 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
12534 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
12535
12536 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
12537 character code conversion as well as other things.
12538
12539 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
12540 (formerly it did not).
12541
12542 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
12543 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
12544
12545 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
12546 instead of constant strings.
12547
12548 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
12549 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
12550 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
12551
12552 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
12553 in the same way as before.
12554
12555 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
12556 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
12557 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
12558
12559 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
12560 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
12561 else, and returns nil.
12562
12563 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
12564 directory cannot be listed.
12565
12566 ** Changes in minibuffer input
12567
12568 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
12569 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
12570 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
12571 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
12572 ways:
12573
12574 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
12575 It is available through the history command M-n.
12576
12577 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
12578 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
12579 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
12580 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
12581 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
12582
12583 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
12584 argument in this way.
12585
12586 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
12587 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
12588 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
12589
12590 ** Echo area features
12591
12592 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
12593 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
12594 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
12595 after the echo area is cleared.
12596
12597 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
12598 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
12599
12600 ** Keyboard input features
12601
12602 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
12603 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
12604
12605 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
12606 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
12607 by keyboard macros.
12608
12609 ** Frame-related changes
12610
12611 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
12612 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
12613 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
12614
12615 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
12616 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
12617 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
12618
12619 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12620 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
12621 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
12622 in the selected frame.
12623
12624 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
12625 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
12626 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
12627
12628 ** X Windows features
12629
12630 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
12631 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
12632 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
12633
12634 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
12635 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
12636
12637 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
12638 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
12639 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
12640
12641 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
12642 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
12643
12644 ** Subprocess features
12645
12646 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
12647 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
12648 automatically.
12649
12650 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
12651 and returns the output from the command as a string.
12652
12653 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
12654 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
12655
12656 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
12657 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
12658
12659 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
12660 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
12661 goes after the other menu items.
12662
12663 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
12664 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
12665 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
12666 are in use.
12667
12668 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
12669 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
12670
12671 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
12672 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
12673 form.
12674
12675 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
12676 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
12677 but its hook is still run.
12678
12679 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
12680 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
12681
12682 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
12683 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
12684 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
12685
12686 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
12687 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
12688 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
12689 warned.
12690
12691 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
12692 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
12693
12694 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
12695 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
12696 functions like display-time.
12697
12698 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
12699 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
12700
12701 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
12702 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
12703 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
12704
12705 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
12706 if there is an error in compilation.
12707
12708 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
12709 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
12710 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
12711 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
12712
12713 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
12714 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
12715 the *scratch* buffer.
12716
12717 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
12718 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
12719 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
12720 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
12721
12722 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
12723 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
12724 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
12725
12726 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
12727 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
12728 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
12729 and compose-mail-other-frame.
12730
12731 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
12732 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
12733 full name of the specified user will be returned.
12734
12735 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
12736 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
12737 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
12738 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
12739 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
12740 files at all.
12741
12742 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
12743 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
12744 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
12745 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
12746
12747 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
12748 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
12749 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
12750 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
12751
12752 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
12753
12754 ** imenu.el changes.
12755
12756 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
12757 item from menu created by imenu.
12758
12759 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
12760 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
12761 select one of those items.
12762 \f
12763 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
12764
12765 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
12766 Copyright information:
12767
12768 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12769
12770 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
12771 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
12772 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
12773 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
12774
12775 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
12776 of this document, or of portions of it,
12777 under the above conditions, provided also that they
12778 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
12779 \f
12780 Local variables:
12781 mode: outline
12782 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
12783 end:
12784
12785 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793